clang 22.0.0git
TypeBase.h
Go to the documentation of this file.
1//===- TypeBase.h - C Language Family Type Representation -------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4// See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5// SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6//
7//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8//
9/// \file
10/// C Language Family Type Representation
11///
12/// This file defines the clang::Type interface and subclasses, used to
13/// represent types for languages in the C family.
14//
15//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
16
17#ifndef LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_BASE_H
18#define LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_BASE_H
19
27#include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
29#include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
35#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
36#include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
37#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
38#include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
39#include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h"
40#include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
41#include "llvm/ADT/STLForwardCompat.h"
42#include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
43#include "llvm/ADT/Twine.h"
44#include "llvm/ADT/iterator_range.h"
45#include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
46#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
47#include "llvm/Support/DXILABI.h"
48#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
49#include "llvm/Support/PointerLikeTypeTraits.h"
50#include "llvm/Support/TrailingObjects.h"
51#include "llvm/Support/type_traits.h"
52#include <bitset>
53#include <cassert>
54#include <cstddef>
55#include <cstdint>
56#include <cstring>
57#include <optional>
58#include <string>
59#include <type_traits>
60#include <utility>
61
62namespace clang {
63
64class BTFTypeTagAttr;
65class ExtQuals;
66class QualType;
67class ConceptDecl;
68class ValueDecl;
69class TagDecl;
71class Type;
72class Attr;
73
74enum {
77};
78
79namespace serialization {
80 template <class T> class AbstractTypeReader;
81 template <class T> class AbstractTypeWriter;
82}
83
84} // namespace clang
85
86namespace llvm {
87
88 template <typename T>
90 template<>
92 static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(::clang::Type *P) { return P; }
93
94 static inline ::clang::Type *getFromVoidPointer(void *P) {
95 return static_cast< ::clang::Type*>(P);
96 }
97
99 };
100
101 template<>
103 static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(::clang::ExtQuals *P) { return P; }
104
105 static inline ::clang::ExtQuals *getFromVoidPointer(void *P) {
106 return static_cast< ::clang::ExtQuals*>(P);
107 }
108
110 };
111
112} // namespace llvm
113
114namespace clang {
115
116class ASTContext;
117template <typename> class CanQual;
118class CXXRecordDecl;
119class DeclContext;
120class EnumDecl;
121class Expr;
122class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase;
123class FunctionDecl;
124class FunctionEffectsRef;
125class FunctionEffectKindSet;
126class FunctionEffectSet;
127class IdentifierInfo;
128class NamedDecl;
129class ObjCInterfaceDecl;
130class ObjCProtocolDecl;
131class ObjCTypeParamDecl;
132struct PrintingPolicy;
133class RecordDecl;
134class Stmt;
135class TagDecl;
136class ClassTemplateDecl;
137class TemplateArgument;
138class TemplateArgumentListInfo;
139class TemplateArgumentLoc;
140class TemplateTypeParmDecl;
141class TypedefNameDecl;
142class UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl;
143class UsingShadowDecl;
144
145using CanQualType = CanQual<Type>;
146
147// Provide forward declarations for all of the *Type classes.
148#define TYPE(Class, Base) class Class##Type;
149#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
150
151/// Pointer-authentication qualifiers.
152class PointerAuthQualifier {
153 enum : uint32_t {
154 EnabledShift = 0,
155 EnabledBits = 1,
156 EnabledMask = 1 << EnabledShift,
157 AddressDiscriminatedShift = EnabledShift + EnabledBits,
158 AddressDiscriminatedBits = 1,
159 AddressDiscriminatedMask = 1 << AddressDiscriminatedShift,
160 AuthenticationModeShift =
161 AddressDiscriminatedShift + AddressDiscriminatedBits,
162 AuthenticationModeBits = 2,
163 AuthenticationModeMask = ((1 << AuthenticationModeBits) - 1)
164 << AuthenticationModeShift,
165 IsaPointerShift = AuthenticationModeShift + AuthenticationModeBits,
166 IsaPointerBits = 1,
167 IsaPointerMask = ((1 << IsaPointerBits) - 1) << IsaPointerShift,
168 AuthenticatesNullValuesShift = IsaPointerShift + IsaPointerBits,
169 AuthenticatesNullValuesBits = 1,
170 AuthenticatesNullValuesMask = ((1 << AuthenticatesNullValuesBits) - 1)
171 << AuthenticatesNullValuesShift,
172 KeyShift = AuthenticatesNullValuesShift + AuthenticatesNullValuesBits,
173 KeyBits = 10,
174 KeyMask = ((1 << KeyBits) - 1) << KeyShift,
175 DiscriminatorShift = KeyShift + KeyBits,
176 DiscriminatorBits = 16,
177 DiscriminatorMask = ((1u << DiscriminatorBits) - 1) << DiscriminatorShift,
178 };
179
180 // bits: |0 |1 |2..3 |4 |
181 // |Enabled|Address|AuthenticationMode|ISA pointer|
182 // bits: |5 |6..15| 16...31 |
183 // |AuthenticatesNull|Key |Discriminator|
184 uint32_t Data = 0;
185
186 // The following static assertions check that each of the 32 bits is present
187 // exactly in one of the constants.
188 static_assert((EnabledBits + AddressDiscriminatedBits +
189 AuthenticationModeBits + IsaPointerBits +
190 AuthenticatesNullValuesBits + KeyBits + DiscriminatorBits) ==
191 32,
192 "PointerAuthQualifier should be exactly 32 bits");
193 static_assert((EnabledMask + AddressDiscriminatedMask +
194 AuthenticationModeMask + IsaPointerMask +
195 AuthenticatesNullValuesMask + KeyMask + DiscriminatorMask) ==
196 0xFFFFFFFF,
197 "All masks should cover the entire bits");
198 static_assert((EnabledMask ^ AddressDiscriminatedMask ^
199 AuthenticationModeMask ^ IsaPointerMask ^
200 AuthenticatesNullValuesMask ^ KeyMask ^ DiscriminatorMask) ==
201 0xFFFFFFFF,
202 "All masks should cover the entire bits");
203
204 PointerAuthQualifier(unsigned Key, bool IsAddressDiscriminated,
205 unsigned ExtraDiscriminator,
206 PointerAuthenticationMode AuthenticationMode,
207 bool IsIsaPointer, bool AuthenticatesNullValues)
208 : Data(EnabledMask |
209 (IsAddressDiscriminated
210 ? llvm::to_underlying(AddressDiscriminatedMask)
211 : 0) |
212 (Key << KeyShift) |
213 (llvm::to_underlying(AuthenticationMode)
214 << AuthenticationModeShift) |
215 (ExtraDiscriminator << DiscriminatorShift) |
216 (IsIsaPointer << IsaPointerShift) |
217 (AuthenticatesNullValues << AuthenticatesNullValuesShift)) {
218 assert(Key <= KeyNoneInternal);
219 assert(ExtraDiscriminator <= MaxDiscriminator);
220 assert((Data == 0) ==
222 }
223
224public:
225 enum {
226 KeyNoneInternal = (1u << KeyBits) - 1,
227
228 /// The maximum supported pointer-authentication key.
230
231 /// The maximum supported pointer-authentication discriminator.
232 MaxDiscriminator = (1u << DiscriminatorBits) - 1
233 };
234
235public:
237
238 static PointerAuthQualifier
239 Create(unsigned Key, bool IsAddressDiscriminated, unsigned ExtraDiscriminator,
240 PointerAuthenticationMode AuthenticationMode, bool IsIsaPointer,
241 bool AuthenticatesNullValues) {
242 if (Key == PointerAuthKeyNone)
243 Key = KeyNoneInternal;
244 assert(Key <= KeyNoneInternal && "out-of-range key value");
245 return PointerAuthQualifier(Key, IsAddressDiscriminated, ExtraDiscriminator,
246 AuthenticationMode, IsIsaPointer,
247 AuthenticatesNullValues);
248 }
249
250 bool isPresent() const {
251 assert((Data == 0) ==
253 return Data != 0;
254 }
255
256 explicit operator bool() const { return isPresent(); }
257
258 unsigned getKey() const {
259 assert(isPresent());
260 return (Data & KeyMask) >> KeyShift;
261 }
262
263 bool hasKeyNone() const { return isPresent() && getKey() == KeyNoneInternal; }
264
266 assert(isPresent());
267 return (Data & AddressDiscriminatedMask) >> AddressDiscriminatedShift;
268 }
269
270 unsigned getExtraDiscriminator() const {
271 assert(isPresent());
272 return (Data >> DiscriminatorShift);
273 }
274
276 return PointerAuthenticationMode((Data & AuthenticationModeMask) >>
277 AuthenticationModeShift);
278 }
279
280 bool isIsaPointer() const {
281 assert(isPresent());
282 return (Data & IsaPointerMask) >> IsaPointerShift;
283 }
284
286 assert(isPresent());
287 return (Data & AuthenticatesNullValuesMask) >> AuthenticatesNullValuesShift;
288 }
289
290 PointerAuthQualifier withoutKeyNone() const {
291 return hasKeyNone() ? PointerAuthQualifier() : *this;
292 }
293
294 friend bool operator==(PointerAuthQualifier Lhs, PointerAuthQualifier Rhs) {
295 return Lhs.Data == Rhs.Data;
296 }
297 friend bool operator!=(PointerAuthQualifier Lhs, PointerAuthQualifier Rhs) {
298 return Lhs.Data != Rhs.Data;
299 }
300
301 bool isEquivalent(PointerAuthQualifier Other) const {
302 return withoutKeyNone() == Other.withoutKeyNone();
303 }
304
305 uint32_t getAsOpaqueValue() const { return Data; }
306
307 // Deserialize pointer-auth qualifiers from an opaque representation.
308 static PointerAuthQualifier fromOpaqueValue(uint32_t Opaque) {
309 PointerAuthQualifier Result;
310 Result.Data = Opaque;
311 assert((Result.Data == 0) ==
312 (Result.getAuthenticationMode() == PointerAuthenticationMode::None));
313 return Result;
314 }
315
316 std::string getAsString() const;
317 std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
318
319 bool isEmptyWhenPrinted(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
320 void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
321
322 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { ID.AddInteger(Data); }
323};
324
325/// The collection of all-type qualifiers we support.
326/// Clang supports five independent qualifiers:
327/// * C99: const, volatile, and restrict
328/// * MS: __unaligned
329/// * Embedded C (TR18037): address spaces
330/// * Objective C: the GC attributes (none, weak, or strong)
332public:
333 Qualifiers() = default;
334 enum TQ : uint64_t {
335 // NOTE: These flags must be kept in sync with DeclSpec::TQ.
336 Const = 0x1,
337 Restrict = 0x2,
338 Volatile = 0x4,
340 };
341
342 enum GC {
346 };
347
349 /// There is no lifetime qualification on this type.
351
352 /// This object can be modified without requiring retains or
353 /// releases.
355
356 /// Assigning into this object requires the old value to be
357 /// released and the new value to be retained. The timing of the
358 /// release of the old value is inexact: it may be moved to
359 /// immediately after the last known point where the value is
360 /// live.
362
363 /// Reading or writing from this object requires a barrier call.
365
366 /// Assigning into this object requires a lifetime extension.
368 };
369
370 enum : uint64_t {
371 /// The maximum supported address space number.
372 /// 23 bits should be enough for anyone.
373 MaxAddressSpace = 0x7fffffu,
374
375 /// The width of the "fast" qualifier mask.
377
378 /// The fast qualifier mask.
379 FastMask = (1 << FastWidth) - 1
380 };
381
382 /// Returns the common set of qualifiers while removing them from
383 /// the given sets.
385 Qualifiers Q;
387 if (LPtrAuth.isPresent() &&
389 LPtrAuth == R.getPointerAuth()) {
390 Q.setPointerAuth(LPtrAuth);
394 }
395
396 // If both are only CVR-qualified, bit operations are sufficient.
397 if (!(L.Mask & ~CVRMask) && !(R.Mask & ~CVRMask)) {
398 Q.Mask = L.Mask & R.Mask;
399 L.Mask &= ~Q.Mask;
400 R.Mask &= ~Q.Mask;
401 return Q;
402 }
403
404 unsigned CommonCRV = L.getCVRQualifiers() & R.getCVRQualifiers();
405 Q.addCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV);
406 L.removeCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV);
407 R.removeCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV);
408
409 if (L.getObjCGCAttr() == R.getObjCGCAttr()) {
413 }
414
415 if (L.getObjCLifetime() == R.getObjCLifetime()) {
419 }
420
421 if (L.getAddressSpace() == R.getAddressSpace()) {
425 }
426 return Q;
427 }
428
429 static Qualifiers fromFastMask(unsigned Mask) {
430 Qualifiers Qs;
431 Qs.addFastQualifiers(Mask);
432 return Qs;
433 }
434
435 static Qualifiers fromCVRMask(unsigned CVR) {
436 Qualifiers Qs;
437 Qs.addCVRQualifiers(CVR);
438 return Qs;
439 }
440
441 static Qualifiers fromCVRUMask(unsigned CVRU) {
442 Qualifiers Qs;
443 Qs.addCVRUQualifiers(CVRU);
444 return Qs;
445 }
446
447 // Deserialize qualifiers from an opaque representation.
448 static Qualifiers fromOpaqueValue(uint64_t opaque) {
449 Qualifiers Qs;
450 Qs.Mask = opaque;
451 return Qs;
452 }
453
454 // Serialize these qualifiers into an opaque representation.
455 uint64_t getAsOpaqueValue() const { return Mask; }
456
457 bool hasConst() const { return Mask & Const; }
458 bool hasOnlyConst() const { return Mask == Const; }
459 void removeConst() { Mask &= ~Const; }
460 void addConst() { Mask |= Const; }
462 Qualifiers Qs = *this;
463 Qs.addConst();
464 return Qs;
465 }
466
467 bool hasVolatile() const { return Mask & Volatile; }
468 bool hasOnlyVolatile() const { return Mask == Volatile; }
469 void removeVolatile() { Mask &= ~Volatile; }
470 void addVolatile() { Mask |= Volatile; }
472 Qualifiers Qs = *this;
473 Qs.addVolatile();
474 return Qs;
475 }
476
477 bool hasRestrict() const { return Mask & Restrict; }
478 bool hasOnlyRestrict() const { return Mask == Restrict; }
479 void removeRestrict() { Mask &= ~Restrict; }
480 void addRestrict() { Mask |= Restrict; }
482 Qualifiers Qs = *this;
483 Qs.addRestrict();
484 return Qs;
485 }
486
487 bool hasCVRQualifiers() const { return getCVRQualifiers(); }
488 unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const { return Mask & CVRMask; }
489 unsigned getCVRUQualifiers() const { return Mask & (CVRMask | UMask); }
490
491 void setCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
492 assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits");
493 Mask = (Mask & ~CVRMask) | mask;
494 }
495 void removeCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
496 assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits");
497 Mask &= ~static_cast<uint64_t>(mask);
498 }
502 void addCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
503 assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits");
504 Mask |= mask;
505 }
506 void addCVRUQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
507 assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask & ~UMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVRU bits");
508 Mask |= mask;
509 }
510
511 bool hasUnaligned() const { return Mask & UMask; }
512 void setUnaligned(bool flag) {
513 Mask = (Mask & ~UMask) | (flag ? UMask : 0);
514 }
515 void removeUnaligned() { Mask &= ~UMask; }
516 void addUnaligned() { Mask |= UMask; }
517
518 bool hasObjCGCAttr() const { return Mask & GCAttrMask; }
519 GC getObjCGCAttr() const { return GC((Mask & GCAttrMask) >> GCAttrShift); }
521 Mask = (Mask & ~GCAttrMask) | (type << GCAttrShift);
522 }
525 assert(type);
527 }
529 Qualifiers qs = *this;
530 qs.removeObjCGCAttr();
531 return qs;
532 }
534 Qualifiers qs = *this;
536 return qs;
537 }
539 Qualifiers qs = *this;
541 return qs;
542 }
543
544 bool hasObjCLifetime() const { return Mask & LifetimeMask; }
546 return ObjCLifetime((Mask & LifetimeMask) >> LifetimeShift);
547 }
549 Mask = (Mask & ~LifetimeMask) | (type << LifetimeShift);
550 }
553 assert(type);
554 assert(!hasObjCLifetime());
555 Mask |= (type << LifetimeShift);
556 }
557
558 /// True if the lifetime is neither None or ExplicitNone.
560 ObjCLifetime lifetime = getObjCLifetime();
561 return (lifetime > OCL_ExplicitNone);
562 }
563
564 /// True if the lifetime is either strong or weak.
566 ObjCLifetime lifetime = getObjCLifetime();
567 return (lifetime == OCL_Strong || lifetime == OCL_Weak);
568 }
569
570 bool hasAddressSpace() const { return Mask & AddressSpaceMask; }
572 return static_cast<LangAS>((Mask & AddressSpaceMask) >> AddressSpaceShift);
573 }
577 /// Get the address space attribute value to be printed by diagnostics.
579 auto Addr = getAddressSpace();
580 // This function is not supposed to be used with language specific
581 // address spaces. If that happens, the diagnostic message should consider
582 // printing the QualType instead of the address space value.
584 if (Addr != LangAS::Default)
586 // TODO: The diagnostic messages where Addr may be 0 should be fixed
587 // since it cannot differentiate the situation where 0 denotes the default
588 // address space or user specified __attribute__((address_space(0))).
589 return 0;
590 }
592 assert((unsigned)space <= MaxAddressSpace);
593 Mask = (Mask & ~AddressSpaceMask)
594 | (((uint32_t) space) << AddressSpaceShift);
595 }
598 assert(space != LangAS::Default);
599 setAddressSpace(space);
600 }
601
602 bool hasPointerAuth() const { return Mask & PtrAuthMask; }
604 return PointerAuthQualifier::fromOpaqueValue(Mask >> PtrAuthShift);
605 }
607 Mask = (Mask & ~PtrAuthMask) |
608 (uint64_t(Q.getAsOpaqueValue()) << PtrAuthShift);
609 }
610 void removePointerAuth() { Mask &= ~PtrAuthMask; }
612 assert(Q.isPresent());
614 }
615
616 // Fast qualifiers are those that can be allocated directly
617 // on a QualType object.
618 bool hasFastQualifiers() const { return getFastQualifiers(); }
619 unsigned getFastQualifiers() const { return Mask & FastMask; }
620 void setFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
621 assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits");
622 Mask = (Mask & ~FastMask) | mask;
623 }
624 void removeFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
625 assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits");
626 Mask &= ~static_cast<uint64_t>(mask);
627 }
631 void addFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) {
632 assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits");
633 Mask |= mask;
634 }
635
636 /// Return true if the set contains any qualifiers which require an ExtQuals
637 /// node to be allocated.
638 bool hasNonFastQualifiers() const { return Mask & ~FastMask; }
640 Qualifiers Quals = *this;
641 Quals.setFastQualifiers(0);
642 return Quals;
643 }
644
645 /// Return true if the set contains any qualifiers.
646 bool hasQualifiers() const { return Mask; }
647 bool empty() const { return !Mask; }
648
649 /// Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set.
651 // If the other set doesn't have any non-boolean qualifiers, just
652 // bit-or it in.
653 if (!(Q.Mask & ~CVRMask))
654 Mask |= Q.Mask;
655 else {
656 Mask |= (Q.Mask & CVRMask);
657 if (Q.hasAddressSpace())
659 if (Q.hasObjCGCAttr())
661 if (Q.hasObjCLifetime())
663 if (Q.hasPointerAuth())
665 }
666 }
667
668 /// Remove the qualifiers from the given set from this set.
670 // If the other set doesn't have any non-boolean qualifiers, just
671 // bit-and the inverse in.
672 if (!(Q.Mask & ~CVRMask))
673 Mask &= ~Q.Mask;
674 else {
675 Mask &= ~(Q.Mask & CVRMask);
676 if (getObjCGCAttr() == Q.getObjCGCAttr())
678 if (getObjCLifetime() == Q.getObjCLifetime())
680 if (getAddressSpace() == Q.getAddressSpace())
682 if (getPointerAuth() == Q.getPointerAuth())
684 }
685 }
686
687 /// Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set, given that
688 /// they don't conflict.
690 assert(getAddressSpace() == qs.getAddressSpace() ||
691 !hasAddressSpace() || !qs.hasAddressSpace());
692 assert(getObjCGCAttr() == qs.getObjCGCAttr() ||
693 !hasObjCGCAttr() || !qs.hasObjCGCAttr());
694 assert(getObjCLifetime() == qs.getObjCLifetime() ||
695 !hasObjCLifetime() || !qs.hasObjCLifetime());
696 assert(!hasPointerAuth() || !qs.hasPointerAuth() ||
698 Mask |= qs.Mask;
699 }
700
701 /// Returns true if address space A is equal to or a superset of B.
702 /// OpenCL v2.0 defines conversion rules (OpenCLC v2.0 s6.5.5) and notion of
703 /// overlapping address spaces.
704 /// CL1.1 or CL1.2:
705 /// every address space is a superset of itself.
706 /// CL2.0 adds:
707 /// __generic is a superset of any address space except for __constant.
709 const ASTContext &Ctx) {
710 // Address spaces must match exactly.
711 return A == B || isTargetAddressSpaceSupersetOf(A, B, Ctx);
712 }
713
715 const ASTContext &Ctx);
716
717 /// Returns true if the address space in these qualifiers is equal to or
718 /// a superset of the address space in the argument qualifiers.
719 bool isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(Qualifiers other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const {
721 Ctx);
722 }
723
724 /// Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set.
725 /// Generally this answers the question of whether an object with the other
726 /// qualifiers can be safely used as an object with these qualifiers.
727 bool compatiblyIncludes(Qualifiers other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const {
728 return isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(other, Ctx) &&
729 // ObjC GC qualifiers can match, be added, or be removed, but can't
730 // be changed.
731 (getObjCGCAttr() == other.getObjCGCAttr() || !hasObjCGCAttr() ||
732 !other.hasObjCGCAttr()) &&
733 // Pointer-auth qualifiers must match exactly.
734 getPointerAuth() == other.getPointerAuth() &&
735 // ObjC lifetime qualifiers must match exactly.
736 getObjCLifetime() == other.getObjCLifetime() &&
737 // CVR qualifiers may subset.
738 (((Mask & CVRMask) | (other.Mask & CVRMask)) == (Mask & CVRMask)) &&
739 // U qualifier may superset.
740 (!other.hasUnaligned() || hasUnaligned());
741 }
742
743 /// Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set of
744 /// qualifiers from the narrow perspective of Objective-C ARC lifetime.
745 ///
746 /// One set of Objective-C lifetime qualifiers compatibly includes the other
747 /// if the lifetime qualifiers match, or if both are non-__weak and the
748 /// including set also contains the 'const' qualifier, or both are non-__weak
749 /// and one is None (which can only happen in non-ARC modes).
751 if (getObjCLifetime() == other.getObjCLifetime())
752 return true;
753
754 if (getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak || other.getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak)
755 return false;
756
757 if (getObjCLifetime() == OCL_None || other.getObjCLifetime() == OCL_None)
758 return true;
759
760 return hasConst();
761 }
762
763 /// Determine whether this set of qualifiers is a strict superset of
764 /// another set of qualifiers, not considering qualifier compatibility.
766
767 bool operator==(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask == Other.Mask; }
768 bool operator!=(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask != Other.Mask; }
769
770 explicit operator bool() const { return hasQualifiers(); }
771
773 addQualifiers(R);
774 return *this;
775 }
776
777 // Union two qualifier sets. If an enumerated qualifier appears
778 // in both sets, use the one from the right.
780 L += R;
781 return L;
782 }
783
786 return *this;
787 }
788
789 /// Compute the difference between two qualifier sets.
791 L -= R;
792 return L;
793 }
794
795 std::string getAsString() const;
796 std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
797
798 static std::string getAddrSpaceAsString(LangAS AS);
799
800 bool isEmptyWhenPrinted(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
801 void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy,
802 bool appendSpaceIfNonEmpty = false) const;
803
804 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { ID.AddInteger(Mask); }
805
806private:
807 // bits: |0 1 2|3|4 .. 5|6 .. 8|9 ... 31|32 ... 63|
808 // |C R V|U|GCAttr|Lifetime|AddressSpace| PtrAuth |
809 uint64_t Mask = 0;
810 static_assert(sizeof(PointerAuthQualifier) == sizeof(uint32_t),
811 "PointerAuthQualifier must be 32 bits");
812
813 static constexpr uint64_t PtrAuthShift = 32;
814 static constexpr uint64_t PtrAuthMask = UINT64_C(0xffffffff) << PtrAuthShift;
815
816 static constexpr uint64_t UMask = 0x8;
817 static constexpr uint64_t UShift = 3;
818 static constexpr uint64_t GCAttrMask = 0x30;
819 static constexpr uint64_t GCAttrShift = 4;
820 static constexpr uint64_t LifetimeMask = 0x1C0;
821 static constexpr uint64_t LifetimeShift = 6;
822 static constexpr uint64_t AddressSpaceMask =
823 ~(CVRMask | UMask | GCAttrMask | LifetimeMask | PtrAuthMask);
824 static constexpr uint64_t AddressSpaceShift = 9;
825};
826
828 Qualifiers Quals;
829 bool HasAtomic;
830
831public:
832 QualifiersAndAtomic() : HasAtomic(false) {}
833 QualifiersAndAtomic(Qualifiers Quals, bool HasAtomic)
834 : Quals(Quals), HasAtomic(HasAtomic) {}
835
836 operator Qualifiers() const { return Quals; }
837
838 bool hasVolatile() const { return Quals.hasVolatile(); }
839 bool hasConst() const { return Quals.hasConst(); }
840 bool hasRestrict() const { return Quals.hasRestrict(); }
841 bool hasAtomic() const { return HasAtomic; }
842
843 void addVolatile() { Quals.addVolatile(); }
844 void addConst() { Quals.addConst(); }
845 void addRestrict() { Quals.addRestrict(); }
846 void addAtomic() { HasAtomic = true; }
847
848 void removeVolatile() { Quals.removeVolatile(); }
849 void removeConst() { Quals.removeConst(); }
850 void removeRestrict() { Quals.removeRestrict(); }
851 void removeAtomic() { HasAtomic = false; }
852
854 return {Quals.withVolatile(), HasAtomic};
855 }
856 QualifiersAndAtomic withConst() { return {Quals.withConst(), HasAtomic}; }
858 return {Quals.withRestrict(), HasAtomic};
859 }
860 QualifiersAndAtomic withAtomic() { return {Quals, true}; }
861
863 Quals += RHS;
864 return *this;
865 }
866};
867
868/// A std::pair-like structure for storing a qualified type split
869/// into its local qualifiers and its locally-unqualified type.
871 /// The locally-unqualified type.
872 const Type *Ty = nullptr;
873
874 /// The local qualifiers.
876
877 SplitQualType() = default;
878 SplitQualType(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs) : Ty(ty), Quals(qs) {}
879
880 SplitQualType getSingleStepDesugaredType() const; // end of this file
881
882 // Make std::tie work.
883 std::pair<const Type *,Qualifiers> asPair() const {
884 return std::pair<const Type *, Qualifiers>(Ty, Quals);
885 }
886
888 return a.Ty == b.Ty && a.Quals == b.Quals;
889 }
891 return a.Ty != b.Ty || a.Quals != b.Quals;
892 }
893};
894
895/// The kind of type we are substituting Objective-C type arguments into.
896///
897/// The kind of substitution affects the replacement of type parameters when
898/// no concrete type information is provided, e.g., when dealing with an
899/// unspecialized type.
901 /// An ordinary type.
903
904 /// The result type of a method or function.
906
907 /// The parameter type of a method or function.
909
910 /// The type of a property.
912
913 /// The superclass of a type.
915};
916
917/// The kind of 'typeof' expression we're after.
918enum class TypeOfKind : uint8_t {
921};
922
923/// A (possibly-)qualified type.
924///
925/// For efficiency, we don't store CV-qualified types as nodes on their
926/// own: instead each reference to a type stores the qualifiers. This
927/// greatly reduces the number of nodes we need to allocate for types (for
928/// example we only need one for 'int', 'const int', 'volatile int',
929/// 'const volatile int', etc).
930///
931/// As an added efficiency bonus, instead of making this a pair, we
932/// just store the two bits we care about in the low bits of the
933/// pointer. To handle the packing/unpacking, we make QualType be a
934/// simple wrapper class that acts like a smart pointer. A third bit
935/// indicates whether there are extended qualifiers present, in which
936/// case the pointer points to a special structure.
937class QualType {
938 friend class QualifierCollector;
939
940 // Thankfully, these are efficiently composable.
941 llvm::PointerIntPair<llvm::PointerUnion<const Type *, const ExtQuals *>,
943
944 const ExtQuals *getExtQualsUnsafe() const {
945 return cast<const ExtQuals *>(Value.getPointer());
946 }
947
948 const Type *getTypePtrUnsafe() const {
949 return cast<const Type *>(Value.getPointer());
950 }
951
952 const ExtQualsTypeCommonBase *getCommonPtr() const {
953 assert(!isNull() && "Cannot retrieve a NULL type pointer");
954 auto CommonPtrVal = reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(Value.getOpaqueValue());
955 CommonPtrVal &= ~(uintptr_t)((1 << TypeAlignmentInBits) - 1);
956 return reinterpret_cast<ExtQualsTypeCommonBase*>(CommonPtrVal);
957 }
958
959public:
960 QualType() = default;
961 QualType(const Type *Ptr, unsigned Quals) : Value(Ptr, Quals) {}
962 QualType(const ExtQuals *Ptr, unsigned Quals) : Value(Ptr, Quals) {}
963
964 unsigned getLocalFastQualifiers() const { return Value.getInt(); }
965 void setLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Quals) { Value.setInt(Quals); }
966
967 bool UseExcessPrecision(const ASTContext &Ctx);
968
969 /// Retrieves a pointer to the underlying (unqualified) type.
970 ///
971 /// This function requires that the type not be NULL. If the type might be
972 /// NULL, use the (slightly less efficient) \c getTypePtrOrNull().
973 const Type *getTypePtr() const;
974
975 const Type *getTypePtrOrNull() const;
976
977 /// Retrieves a pointer to the name of the base type.
979
980 /// Divides a QualType into its unqualified type and a set of local
981 /// qualifiers.
982 SplitQualType split() const;
983
984 void *getAsOpaquePtr() const { return Value.getOpaqueValue(); }
985
986 static QualType getFromOpaquePtr(const void *Ptr) {
987 QualType T;
988 T.Value.setFromOpaqueValue(const_cast<void*>(Ptr));
989 return T;
990 }
991
992 const Type &operator*() const {
993 return *getTypePtr();
994 }
995
996 const Type *operator->() const {
997 return getTypePtr();
998 }
999
1000 bool isCanonical() const;
1001 bool isCanonicalAsParam() const;
1002
1003 /// Return true if this QualType doesn't point to a type yet.
1004 bool isNull() const {
1005 return Value.getPointer().isNull();
1006 }
1007
1008 // Determines if a type can form `T&`.
1009 bool isReferenceable() const;
1010
1011 /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
1012 /// "const" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
1013 /// added "const" at a different level.
1016 }
1017
1018 /// Determine whether this type is const-qualified.
1019 bool isConstQualified() const;
1020
1027 /// Determine whether instances of this type can be placed in immutable
1028 /// storage.
1029 /// If ExcludeCtor is true, the duration when the object's constructor runs
1030 /// will not be considered. The caller will need to verify that the object is
1031 /// not written to during its construction. ExcludeDtor works similarly.
1032 std::optional<NonConstantStorageReason>
1033 isNonConstantStorage(const ASTContext &Ctx, bool ExcludeCtor,
1034 bool ExcludeDtor);
1035
1036 bool isConstantStorage(const ASTContext &Ctx, bool ExcludeCtor,
1037 bool ExcludeDtor) {
1038 return !isNonConstantStorage(Ctx, ExcludeCtor, ExcludeDtor);
1039 }
1040
1041 /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
1042 /// "restrict" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
1043 /// added "restrict" at a different level.
1047
1048 /// Determine whether this type is restrict-qualified.
1049 bool isRestrictQualified() const;
1050
1051 /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
1052 /// "volatile" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
1053 /// added "volatile" at a different level.
1057
1058 /// Determine whether this type is volatile-qualified.
1059 bool isVolatileQualified() const;
1060
1061 /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any
1062 /// qualifiers, without looking through any typedefs that might add
1063 /// qualifiers at a different level.
1067
1068 /// Determine whether this type has any qualifiers.
1069 bool hasQualifiers() const;
1070
1071 /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any
1072 /// "non-fast" qualifiers, e.g., those that are stored in an ExtQualType
1073 /// instance.
1075 return isa<const ExtQuals *>(Value.getPointer());
1076 }
1077
1078 /// Retrieve the set of qualifiers local to this particular QualType
1079 /// instance, not including any qualifiers acquired through typedefs or
1080 /// other sugar.
1082
1083 /// Retrieve the set of qualifiers applied to this type.
1084 Qualifiers getQualifiers() const;
1085
1086 /// Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
1087 /// local to this particular QualType instance, not including any qualifiers
1088 /// acquired through typedefs or other sugar.
1089 unsigned getLocalCVRQualifiers() const {
1090 return getLocalFastQualifiers();
1091 }
1092
1093 /// Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
1094 /// applied to this type.
1095 unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const;
1096
1097 bool isConstant(const ASTContext& Ctx) const {
1098 return QualType::isConstant(*this, Ctx);
1099 }
1100
1101 /// Determine whether this is a Plain Old Data (POD) type (C++ 3.9p10).
1102 bool isPODType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1103
1104 /// Return true if this is a POD type according to the rules of the C++98
1105 /// standard, regardless of the current compilation's language.
1106 bool isCXX98PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1107
1108 /// Return true if this is a POD type according to the more relaxed rules
1109 /// of the C++11 standard, regardless of the current compilation's language.
1110 /// (C++0x [basic.types]p9). Note that, unlike
1111 /// CXXRecordDecl::isCXX11StandardLayout, this takes DRs into account.
1112 bool isCXX11PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1113
1114 /// Return true if this is a trivial type per (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
1115 bool isTrivialType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1116
1117 /// Return true if this is a trivially copyable type (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
1118 bool isTriviallyCopyableType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1119
1120 /// Return true if the type is safe to bitwise copy using memcpy/memmove.
1121 ///
1122 /// This is an extension in clang: bitwise cloneable types act as trivially
1123 /// copyable types, meaning their underlying bytes can be safely copied by
1124 /// memcpy or memmove. After the copy, the destination object has the same
1125 /// object representation.
1126 ///
1127 /// However, there are cases where it is not safe to copy:
1128 /// - When sanitizers, such as AddressSanitizer, add padding with poison,
1129 /// which can cause issues if those poisoned padding bits are accessed.
1130 /// - Types with Objective-C lifetimes, where specific runtime
1131 /// semantics may not be preserved during a bitwise copy.
1132 bool isBitwiseCloneableType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1133
1134 /// Return true if this is a trivially copyable type
1135 bool isTriviallyCopyConstructibleType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1136
1137 /// Returns true if it is a class and it might be dynamic.
1138 bool mayBeDynamicClass() const;
1139
1140 /// Returns true if it is not a class or if the class might not be dynamic.
1141 bool mayBeNotDynamicClass() const;
1142
1143 /// Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Reference Type.
1144 bool isWebAssemblyReferenceType() const;
1145
1146 /// Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Externref Type.
1147 bool isWebAssemblyExternrefType() const;
1148
1149 /// Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Funcref Type.
1150 bool isWebAssemblyFuncrefType() const;
1151
1152 // Don't promise in the API that anything besides 'const' can be
1153 // easily added.
1154
1155 /// Add the `const` type qualifier to this QualType.
1162
1163 /// Add the `volatile` type qualifier to this QualType.
1170
1171 /// Add the `restrict` qualifier to this QualType.
1178
1179 QualType withCVRQualifiers(unsigned CVR) const {
1180 return withFastQualifiers(CVR);
1181 }
1182
1183 void addFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) {
1184 assert(!(TQs & ~Qualifiers::FastMask)
1185 && "non-fast qualifier bits set in mask!");
1186 Value.setInt(Value.getInt() | TQs);
1187 }
1188
1189 void removeLocalConst();
1190 void removeLocalVolatile();
1191 void removeLocalRestrict();
1192
1193 void removeLocalFastQualifiers() { Value.setInt(0); }
1194 void removeLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Mask) {
1195 assert(!(Mask & ~Qualifiers::FastMask) && "mask has non-fast qualifiers");
1196 Value.setInt(Value.getInt() & ~Mask);
1197 }
1198
1199 // Creates a type with the given qualifiers in addition to any
1200 // qualifiers already on this type.
1201 QualType withFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) const {
1202 QualType T = *this;
1203 T.addFastQualifiers(TQs);
1204 return T;
1205 }
1206
1207 // Creates a type with exactly the given fast qualifiers, removing
1208 // any existing fast qualifiers.
1212
1213 // Removes fast qualifiers, but leaves any extended qualifiers in place.
1215 QualType T = *this;
1216 T.removeLocalFastQualifiers();
1217 return T;
1218 }
1219
1220 QualType getCanonicalType() const;
1221
1222 /// Return this type with all of the instance-specific qualifiers
1223 /// removed, but without removing any qualifiers that may have been applied
1224 /// through typedefs.
1226
1227 /// Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type,
1228 /// removing as little sugar as possible.
1229 ///
1230 /// This routine looks through various kinds of sugar to find the
1231 /// least-desugared type that is unqualified. For example, given:
1232 ///
1233 /// \code
1234 /// typedef int Integer;
1235 /// typedef const Integer CInteger;
1236 /// typedef CInteger DifferenceType;
1237 /// \endcode
1238 ///
1239 /// Executing \c getUnqualifiedType() on the type \c DifferenceType will
1240 /// desugar until we hit the type \c Integer, which has no qualifiers on it.
1241 ///
1242 /// The resulting type might still be qualified if it's sugar for an array
1243 /// type. To strip qualifiers even from within a sugared array type, use
1244 /// ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType.
1245 ///
1246 /// Note: In C, the _Atomic qualifier is special (see C23 6.2.5p32 for
1247 /// details), and it is not stripped by this function. Use
1248 /// getAtomicUnqualifiedType() to strip qualifiers including _Atomic.
1249 inline QualType getUnqualifiedType() const;
1250
1251 /// Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type, removing as little
1252 /// sugar as possible.
1253 ///
1254 /// Like getUnqualifiedType(), but also returns the set of
1255 /// qualifiers that were built up.
1256 ///
1257 /// The resulting type might still be qualified if it's sugar for an array
1258 /// type. To strip qualifiers even from within a sugared array type, use
1259 /// ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType.
1261
1262 /// Determine whether this type is more qualified than the other
1263 /// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers.
1264 bool isMoreQualifiedThan(QualType Other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
1265
1266 /// Determine whether this type is at least as qualified as the other
1267 /// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers.
1268 bool isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(QualType Other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
1269
1271
1272 /// Determine the type of a (typically non-lvalue) expression with the
1273 /// specified result type.
1274 ///
1275 /// This routine should be used for expressions for which the return type is
1276 /// explicitly specified (e.g., in a cast or call) and isn't necessarily
1277 /// an lvalue. It removes a top-level reference (since there are no
1278 /// expressions of reference type) and deletes top-level cvr-qualifiers
1279 /// from non-class types (in C++) or all types (in C).
1280 QualType getNonLValueExprType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1281
1282 /// Remove an outer pack expansion type (if any) from this type. Used as part
1283 /// of converting the type of a declaration to the type of an expression that
1284 /// references that expression. It's meaningless for an expression to have a
1285 /// pack expansion type.
1287
1288 /// Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from
1289 /// the type. This takes off typedefs, typeof's etc. If the outer level of
1290 /// the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified. This is similar
1291 /// to getting the canonical type, but it doesn't remove *all* typedefs. For
1292 /// example, it returns "T*" as "T*", (not as "int*"), because the pointer is
1293 /// concrete.
1294 ///
1295 /// Qualifiers are left in place.
1296 QualType getDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const {
1297 return getDesugaredType(*this, Context);
1298 }
1299
1301 return getSplitDesugaredType(*this);
1302 }
1303
1304 /// Return the specified type with one level of "sugar" removed from
1305 /// the type.
1306 ///
1307 /// This routine takes off the first typedef, typeof, etc. If the outer level
1308 /// of the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified.
1310 return getSingleStepDesugaredTypeImpl(*this, Context);
1311 }
1312
1313 /// Returns the specified type after dropping any
1314 /// outer-level parentheses.
1316 if (isa<ParenType>(*this))
1317 return QualType::IgnoreParens(*this);
1318 return *this;
1319 }
1320
1321 /// Indicate whether the specified types and qualifiers are identical.
1322 friend bool operator==(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) {
1323 return LHS.Value == RHS.Value;
1324 }
1325 friend bool operator!=(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) {
1326 return LHS.Value != RHS.Value;
1327 }
1328 friend bool operator<(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) {
1329 return LHS.Value < RHS.Value;
1330 }
1331
1332 static std::string getAsString(SplitQualType split,
1333 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) {
1334 return getAsString(split.Ty, split.Quals, Policy);
1335 }
1336 static std::string getAsString(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs,
1337 const PrintingPolicy &Policy);
1338
1339 std::string getAsString() const;
1340 std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
1341
1342 void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy,
1343 const Twine &PlaceHolder = Twine(),
1344 unsigned Indentation = 0) const;
1345
1346 static void print(SplitQualType split, raw_ostream &OS,
1347 const PrintingPolicy &policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder,
1348 unsigned Indentation = 0) {
1349 return print(split.Ty, split.Quals, OS, policy, PlaceHolder, Indentation);
1350 }
1351
1352 static void print(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs,
1353 raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &policy,
1354 const Twine &PlaceHolder,
1355 unsigned Indentation = 0);
1356
1357 void getAsStringInternal(std::string &Str,
1358 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
1359
1360 static void getAsStringInternal(SplitQualType split, std::string &out,
1361 const PrintingPolicy &policy) {
1362 return getAsStringInternal(split.Ty, split.Quals, out, policy);
1363 }
1364
1365 static void getAsStringInternal(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs,
1366 std::string &out,
1367 const PrintingPolicy &policy);
1368
1370 const QualType &T;
1371 const PrintingPolicy &Policy;
1372 const Twine &PlaceHolder;
1373 unsigned Indentation;
1374
1375 public:
1377 const Twine &PlaceHolder, unsigned Indentation)
1378 : T(T), Policy(Policy), PlaceHolder(PlaceHolder),
1379 Indentation(Indentation) {}
1380
1381 friend raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS,
1382 const StreamedQualTypeHelper &SQT) {
1383 SQT.T.print(OS, SQT.Policy, SQT.PlaceHolder, SQT.Indentation);
1384 return OS;
1385 }
1386 };
1387
1389 const Twine &PlaceHolder = Twine(),
1390 unsigned Indentation = 0) const {
1391 return StreamedQualTypeHelper(*this, Policy, PlaceHolder, Indentation);
1392 }
1393
1394 void dump(const char *s) const;
1395 void dump() const;
1396 void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS, const ASTContext &Context) const;
1397
1398 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
1399 ID.AddPointer(getAsOpaquePtr());
1400 }
1401
1402 /// Check if this type has any address space qualifier.
1403 inline bool hasAddressSpace() const;
1404
1405 /// Return the address space of this type.
1406 inline LangAS getAddressSpace() const;
1407
1408 /// Returns true if address space qualifiers overlap with T address space
1409 /// qualifiers.
1410 /// OpenCL C defines conversion rules for pointers to different address spaces
1411 /// and notion of overlapping address spaces.
1412 /// CL1.1 or CL1.2:
1413 /// address spaces overlap iff they are they same.
1414 /// OpenCL C v2.0 s6.5.5 adds:
1415 /// __generic overlaps with any address space except for __constant.
1418 Qualifiers TQ = T.getQualifiers();
1419 // Address spaces overlap if at least one of them is a superset of another
1420 return Q.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(TQ, Ctx) ||
1421 TQ.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(Q, Ctx);
1422 }
1423
1424 /// Returns gc attribute of this type.
1425 inline Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const;
1426
1427 /// true when Type is objc's weak.
1428 bool isObjCGCWeak() const {
1429 return getObjCGCAttr() == Qualifiers::Weak;
1430 }
1431
1432 /// true when Type is objc's strong.
1433 bool isObjCGCStrong() const {
1435 }
1436
1437 /// Returns lifetime attribute of this type.
1441
1445
1449
1450 // true when Type is objc's weak and weak is enabled but ARC isn't.
1451 bool isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(const ASTContext &Context) const;
1452
1456
1458 if (PointerAuthQualifier PtrAuth = getPointerAuth())
1459 return PtrAuth.isAddressDiscriminated();
1460 return false;
1461 }
1462
1464 /// The type does not fall into any of the following categories. Note that
1465 /// this case is zero-valued so that values of this enum can be used as a
1466 /// boolean condition for non-triviality.
1468
1469 /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified
1470 /// with the ARC __strong qualifier.
1472
1473 /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified
1474 /// with the ARC __weak qualifier.
1476
1477 /// The type is a struct containing a field whose type is not PCK_Trivial.
1479 };
1480
1481 /// Functions to query basic properties of non-trivial C struct types.
1482
1483 /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct
1484 /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to default initialize
1485 /// and return the kind.
1488
1490 /// The type does not fall into any of the following categories. Note that
1491 /// this case is zero-valued so that values of this enum can be used as a
1492 /// boolean condition for non-triviality.
1494
1495 /// The type would be trivial except that it is volatile-qualified. Types
1496 /// that fall into one of the other non-trivial cases may additionally be
1497 /// volatile-qualified.
1499
1500 /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified
1501 /// with the ARC __strong qualifier.
1503
1504 /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified
1505 /// with the ARC __weak qualifier.
1507
1508 /// The type is an address-discriminated signed pointer type.
1510
1511 /// The type is a struct containing a field whose type is neither
1512 /// PCK_Trivial nor PCK_VolatileTrivial.
1513 /// Note that a C++ struct type does not necessarily match this; C++ copying
1514 /// semantics are too complex to express here, in part because they depend
1515 /// on the exact constructor or assignment operator that is chosen by
1516 /// overload resolution to do the copy.
1518 };
1519
1520 /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct
1521 /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to copy and return the
1522 /// kind.
1524
1525 /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct
1526 /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to destructively
1527 /// move and return the kind. Destructive move in this context is a C++-style
1528 /// move in which the source object is placed in a valid but unspecified state
1529 /// after it is moved, as opposed to a truly destructive move in which the
1530 /// source object is placed in an uninitialized state.
1532
1540
1541 /// Returns a nonzero value if objects of this type require
1542 /// non-trivial work to clean up after. Non-zero because it's
1543 /// conceivable that qualifiers (objc_gc(weak)?) could make
1544 /// something require destruction.
1546 return isDestructedTypeImpl(*this);
1547 }
1548
1549 /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to
1550 /// default-initialize, which is a union that has a member that is non-trivial
1551 /// to default-initialize. If this returns true,
1552 /// isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize returns PDIK_Struct.
1554
1555 /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to destruct,
1556 /// which is a union that has a member that is non-trivial to destruct. If
1557 /// this returns true, isDestructedType returns DK_nontrivial_c_struct.
1559
1560 /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to copy, which
1561 /// is a union that has a member that is non-trivial to copy. If this returns
1562 /// true, isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy returns PCK_Struct.
1564
1565 /// Determine whether expressions of the given type are forbidden
1566 /// from being lvalues in C.
1567 ///
1568 /// The expression types that are forbidden to be lvalues are:
1569 /// - 'void', but not qualified void
1570 /// - function types
1571 ///
1572 /// The exact rule here is C99 6.3.2.1:
1573 /// An lvalue is an expression with an object type or an incomplete
1574 /// type other than void.
1575 bool isCForbiddenLValueType() const;
1576
1577 /// Substitute type arguments for the Objective-C type parameters used in the
1578 /// subject type.
1579 ///
1580 /// \param ctx ASTContext in which the type exists.
1581 ///
1582 /// \param typeArgs The type arguments that will be substituted for the
1583 /// Objective-C type parameters in the subject type, which are generally
1584 /// computed via \c Type::getObjCSubstitutions. If empty, the type
1585 /// parameters will be replaced with their bounds or id/Class, as appropriate
1586 /// for the context.
1587 ///
1588 /// \param context The context in which the subject type was written.
1589 ///
1590 /// \returns the resulting type.
1592 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
1593 ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const;
1594
1595 /// Substitute type arguments from an object type for the Objective-C type
1596 /// parameters used in the subject type.
1597 ///
1598 /// This operation combines the computation of type arguments for
1599 /// substitution (\c Type::getObjCSubstitutions) with the actual process of
1600 /// substitution (\c QualType::substObjCTypeArgs) for the convenience of
1601 /// callers that need to perform a single substitution in isolation.
1602 ///
1603 /// \param objectType The type of the object whose member type we're
1604 /// substituting into. For example, this might be the receiver of a message
1605 /// or the base of a property access.
1606 ///
1607 /// \param dc The declaration context from which the subject type was
1608 /// retrieved, which indicates (for example) which type parameters should
1609 /// be substituted.
1610 ///
1611 /// \param context The context in which the subject type was written.
1612 ///
1613 /// \returns the subject type after replacing all of the Objective-C type
1614 /// parameters with their corresponding arguments.
1616 const DeclContext *dc,
1617 ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const;
1618
1619 /// Strip Objective-C "__kindof" types from the given type.
1620 QualType stripObjCKindOfType(const ASTContext &ctx) const;
1621
1622 /// Remove all qualifiers including _Atomic.
1623 ///
1624 /// Like getUnqualifiedType(), the type may still be qualified if it is a
1625 /// sugared array type. To strip qualifiers even from within a sugared array
1626 /// type, use in conjunction with ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType.
1628
1629private:
1630 // These methods are implemented in a separate translation unit;
1631 // "static"-ize them to avoid creating temporary QualTypes in the
1632 // caller.
1633 static bool isConstant(QualType T, const ASTContext& Ctx);
1634 static QualType getDesugaredType(QualType T, const ASTContext &Context);
1636 static SplitQualType getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(QualType type);
1637 static QualType getSingleStepDesugaredTypeImpl(QualType type,
1638 const ASTContext &C);
1640 static DestructionKind isDestructedTypeImpl(QualType type);
1641
1642 /// Check if \param RD is or contains a non-trivial C union.
1645 static bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(const RecordDecl *RD);
1646};
1647
1648raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, QualType QT);
1649
1650} // namespace clang
1651
1652namespace llvm {
1653
1654/// Implement simplify_type for QualType, so that we can dyn_cast from QualType
1655/// to a specific Type class.
1656template<> struct simplify_type< ::clang::QualType> {
1657 using SimpleType = const ::clang::Type *;
1658
1660 return Val.getTypePtr();
1661 }
1662};
1663
1664// Teach SmallPtrSet that QualType is "basically a pointer".
1665template<>
1666struct PointerLikeTypeTraits<clang::QualType> {
1667 static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(clang::QualType P) {
1668 return P.getAsOpaquePtr();
1669 }
1670
1671 static inline clang::QualType getFromVoidPointer(void *P) {
1673 }
1674
1675 // Various qualifiers go in low bits.
1676 static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = 0;
1677};
1678
1679} // namespace llvm
1680
1681namespace clang {
1682
1683/// Base class that is common to both the \c ExtQuals and \c Type
1684/// classes, which allows \c QualType to access the common fields between the
1685/// two.
1686class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase {
1687 friend class ExtQuals;
1688 friend class QualType;
1689 friend class Type;
1690 friend class ASTReader;
1691
1692 /// The "base" type of an extended qualifiers type (\c ExtQuals) or
1693 /// a self-referential pointer (for \c Type).
1694 ///
1695 /// This pointer allows an efficient mapping from a QualType to its
1696 /// underlying type pointer.
1697 const Type *const BaseType;
1698
1699 /// The canonical type of this type. A QualType.
1700 QualType CanonicalType;
1701
1702 ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(const Type *baseType, QualType canon)
1703 : BaseType(baseType), CanonicalType(canon) {}
1704};
1705
1706/// We can encode up to four bits in the low bits of a
1707/// type pointer, but there are many more type qualifiers that we want
1708/// to be able to apply to an arbitrary type. Therefore we have this
1709/// struct, intended to be heap-allocated and used by QualType to
1710/// store qualifiers.
1711///
1712/// The current design tags the 'const', 'restrict', and 'volatile' qualifiers
1713/// in three low bits on the QualType pointer; a fourth bit records whether
1714/// the pointer is an ExtQuals node. The extended qualifiers (address spaces,
1715/// Objective-C GC attributes) are much more rare.
1716class alignas(TypeAlignment) ExtQuals : public ExtQualsTypeCommonBase,
1717 public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
1718 // NOTE: changing the fast qualifiers should be straightforward as
1719 // long as you don't make 'const' non-fast.
1720 // 1. Qualifiers:
1721 // a) Modify the bitmasks (Qualifiers::TQ and DeclSpec::TQ).
1722 // Fast qualifiers must occupy the low-order bits.
1723 // b) Update Qualifiers::FastWidth and FastMask.
1724 // 2. QualType:
1725 // a) Update is{Volatile,Restrict}Qualified(), defined inline.
1726 // b) Update remove{Volatile,Restrict}, defined near the end of
1727 // this header.
1728 // 3. ASTContext:
1729 // a) Update get{Volatile,Restrict}Type.
1730
1731 /// The immutable set of qualifiers applied by this node. Always contains
1732 /// extended qualifiers.
1733 Qualifiers Quals;
1734
1735 ExtQuals *this_() { return this; }
1736
1737public:
1738 ExtQuals(const Type *baseType, QualType canon, Qualifiers quals)
1739 : ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(baseType,
1740 canon.isNull() ? QualType(this_(), 0) : canon),
1741 Quals(quals) {
1742 assert(Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers()
1743 && "ExtQuals created with no fast qualifiers");
1744 assert(!Quals.hasFastQualifiers()
1745 && "ExtQuals created with fast qualifiers");
1746 }
1747
1748 Qualifiers getQualifiers() const { return Quals; }
1749
1750 bool hasObjCGCAttr() const { return Quals.hasObjCGCAttr(); }
1751 Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const { return Quals.getObjCGCAttr(); }
1752
1753 bool hasObjCLifetime() const { return Quals.hasObjCLifetime(); }
1755 return Quals.getObjCLifetime();
1756 }
1757
1758 bool hasAddressSpace() const { return Quals.hasAddressSpace(); }
1759 LangAS getAddressSpace() const { return Quals.getAddressSpace(); }
1760
1761 const Type *getBaseType() const { return BaseType; }
1762
1763public:
1764 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
1765 Profile(ID, getBaseType(), Quals);
1766 }
1767
1768 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
1769 const Type *BaseType,
1770 Qualifiers Quals) {
1771 assert(!Quals.hasFastQualifiers() && "fast qualifiers in ExtQuals hash!");
1772 ID.AddPointer(BaseType);
1773 Quals.Profile(ID);
1774 }
1775};
1776
1777/// The kind of C++11 ref-qualifier associated with a function type.
1778/// This determines whether a member function's "this" object can be an
1779/// lvalue, rvalue, or neither.
1781 /// No ref-qualifier was provided.
1783
1784 /// An lvalue ref-qualifier was provided (\c &).
1786
1787 /// An rvalue ref-qualifier was provided (\c &&).
1789};
1790
1791/// Which keyword(s) were used to create an AutoType.
1793 /// auto
1795
1796 /// decltype(auto)
1798
1799 /// __auto_type (GNU extension)
1801};
1802
1803enum class ArraySizeModifier;
1804enum class ElaboratedTypeKeyword;
1805enum class VectorKind;
1806
1807/// The base class of the type hierarchy.
1808///
1809/// A central concept with types is that each type always has a canonical
1810/// type. A canonical type is the type with any typedef names stripped out
1811/// of it or the types it references. For example, consider:
1812///
1813/// typedef int foo;
1814/// typedef foo* bar;
1815/// 'int *' 'foo *' 'bar'
1816///
1817/// There will be a Type object created for 'int'. Since int is canonical, its
1818/// CanonicalType pointer points to itself. There is also a Type for 'foo' (a
1819/// TypedefType). Its CanonicalType pointer points to the 'int' Type. Next
1820/// there is a PointerType that represents 'int*', which, like 'int', is
1821/// canonical. Finally, there is a PointerType type for 'foo*' whose canonical
1822/// type is 'int*', and there is a TypedefType for 'bar', whose canonical type
1823/// is also 'int*'.
1824///
1825/// Non-canonical types are useful for emitting diagnostics, without losing
1826/// information about typedefs being used. Canonical types are useful for type
1827/// comparisons (they allow by-pointer equality tests) and useful for reasoning
1828/// about whether something has a particular form (e.g. is a function type),
1829/// because they implicitly, recursively, strip all typedefs out of a type.
1830///
1831/// Types, once created, are immutable.
1832///
1833class alignas(TypeAlignment) Type : public ExtQualsTypeCommonBase {
1834public:
1836#define TYPE(Class, Base) Class,
1837#define LAST_TYPE(Class) TypeLast = Class
1838#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1839#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
1840 };
1841
1842private:
1843 /// Bitfields required by the Type class.
1844 class TypeBitfields {
1845 friend class Type;
1846 template <class T> friend class TypePropertyCache;
1847
1848 /// TypeClass bitfield - Enum that specifies what subclass this belongs to.
1849 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeClass)
1850 unsigned TC : 8;
1851
1852 /// Store information on the type dependency.
1853 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeDependence)
1854 unsigned Dependence : llvm::BitWidth<TypeDependence>;
1855
1856 /// True if the cache (i.e. the bitfields here starting with
1857 /// 'Cache') is valid.
1858 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1859 mutable unsigned CacheValid : 1;
1860
1861 /// Linkage of this type.
1862 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(Linkage)
1863 mutable unsigned CachedLinkage : 3;
1864
1865 /// Whether this type involves and local or unnamed types.
1866 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1867 mutable unsigned CachedLocalOrUnnamed : 1;
1868
1869 /// Whether this type comes from an AST file.
1870 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1871 mutable unsigned FromAST : 1;
1872
1873 bool isCacheValid() const {
1874 return CacheValid;
1875 }
1876
1877 Linkage getLinkage() const {
1878 assert(isCacheValid() && "getting linkage from invalid cache");
1879 return static_cast<Linkage>(CachedLinkage);
1880 }
1881
1882 bool hasLocalOrUnnamedType() const {
1883 assert(isCacheValid() && "getting linkage from invalid cache");
1884 return CachedLocalOrUnnamed;
1885 }
1886 };
1887 enum { NumTypeBits = 8 + llvm::BitWidth<TypeDependence> + 6 };
1888
1889protected:
1890 // These classes allow subclasses to somewhat cleanly pack bitfields
1891 // into Type.
1892
1894 friend class ArrayType;
1895
1896 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
1897 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
1898
1899 /// CVR qualifiers from declarations like
1900 /// 'int X[static restrict 4]'. For function parameters only.
1901 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(Qualifiers)
1902 unsigned IndexTypeQuals : 3;
1903
1904 /// Storage class qualifiers from declarations like
1905 /// 'int X[static restrict 4]'. For function parameters only.
1906 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(ArraySizeModifier)
1907 unsigned SizeModifier : 3;
1908 };
1909 enum { NumArrayTypeBits = NumTypeBits + 6 };
1910
1912 friend class ConstantArrayType;
1913
1914 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(ArrayTypeBitfields)
1916
1917 /// Whether we have a stored size expression.
1918 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1919 unsigned HasExternalSize : 1;
1920
1921 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(unsigned)
1922 unsigned SizeWidth : 5;
1923 };
1924
1926 friend class BuiltinType;
1927
1928 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
1929 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
1930
1931 /// The kind (BuiltinType::Kind) of builtin type this is.
1932 static constexpr unsigned NumOfBuiltinTypeBits = 9;
1933 unsigned Kind : NumOfBuiltinTypeBits;
1934 };
1935
1936public:
1937 static constexpr int FunctionTypeNumParamsWidth = 16;
1938 static constexpr int FunctionTypeNumParamsLimit = (1 << 16) - 1;
1939
1940protected:
1941 /// FunctionTypeBitfields store various bits belonging to FunctionProtoType.
1942 /// Only common bits are stored here. Additional uncommon bits are stored
1943 /// in a trailing object after FunctionProtoType.
1945 friend class FunctionProtoType;
1946 friend class FunctionType;
1947
1948 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
1949 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
1950
1951 /// The ref-qualifier associated with a \c FunctionProtoType.
1952 ///
1953 /// This is a value of type \c RefQualifierKind.
1954 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(RefQualifierKind)
1955 unsigned RefQualifier : 2;
1956
1957 /// Used only by FunctionProtoType, put here to pack with the
1958 /// other bitfields.
1959 /// The qualifiers are part of FunctionProtoType because...
1960 ///
1961 /// C++ 8.3.5p4: The return type, the parameter type list and the
1962 /// cv-qualifier-seq, [...], are part of the function type.
1963 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(Qualifiers)
1964 unsigned FastTypeQuals : Qualifiers::FastWidth;
1965 /// Whether this function has extended Qualifiers.
1966 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1967 unsigned HasExtQuals : 1;
1968
1969 /// The type of exception specification this function has.
1970 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(ExceptionSpecificationType)
1971 unsigned ExceptionSpecType : 4;
1972
1973 /// Whether this function has extended parameter information.
1974 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1975 unsigned HasExtParameterInfos : 1;
1976
1977 /// Whether this function has extra bitfields for the prototype.
1978 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1979 unsigned HasExtraBitfields : 1;
1980
1981 /// Whether the function is variadic.
1982 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1983 unsigned Variadic : 1;
1984
1985 /// Whether this function has a trailing return type.
1986 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1987 unsigned HasTrailingReturn : 1;
1988
1989 /// Whether this function has is a cfi unchecked callee.
1990 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
1991 unsigned CFIUncheckedCallee : 1;
1992
1993 /// Extra information which affects how the function is called, like
1994 /// regparm and the calling convention.
1995 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(CallingConv)
1996 unsigned ExtInfo : 14;
1997
1998 /// The number of parameters this function has, not counting '...'.
1999 /// According to [implimits] 8 bits should be enough here but this is
2000 /// somewhat easy to exceed with metaprogramming and so we would like to
2001 /// keep NumParams as wide as reasonably possible.
2002 unsigned NumParams : FunctionTypeNumParamsWidth;
2003 };
2004
2006 friend class ObjCObjectType;
2007
2008 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2009 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2010
2011 /// The number of type arguments stored directly on this object type.
2012 unsigned NumTypeArgs : 7;
2013
2014 /// The number of protocols stored directly on this object type.
2015 unsigned NumProtocols : 6;
2016
2017 /// Whether this is a "kindof" type.
2018 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2019 unsigned IsKindOf : 1;
2020 };
2021
2023 friend class ReferenceType;
2024
2025 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2026 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2027
2028 /// True if the type was originally spelled with an lvalue sigil.
2029 /// This is never true of rvalue references but can also be false
2030 /// on lvalue references because of C++0x [dcl.typedef]p9,
2031 /// as follows:
2032 ///
2033 /// typedef int &ref; // lvalue, spelled lvalue
2034 /// typedef int &&rvref; // rvalue
2035 /// ref &a; // lvalue, inner ref, spelled lvalue
2036 /// ref &&a; // lvalue, inner ref
2037 /// rvref &a; // lvalue, inner ref, spelled lvalue
2038 /// rvref &&a; // rvalue, inner ref
2039 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2040 unsigned SpelledAsLValue : 1;
2041
2042 /// True if the inner type is a reference type. This only happens
2043 /// in non-canonical forms.
2044 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2045 unsigned InnerRef : 1;
2046 };
2047
2049 template <class> friend class KeywordWrapper;
2050
2051 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2052 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2053
2054 /// An ElaboratedTypeKeyword. 8 bits for efficient access.
2055 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(ElaboratedTypeKeyword)
2056 unsigned Keyword : 8;
2057 };
2058
2059 enum { NumTypeWithKeywordBits = NumTypeBits + 8 };
2060
2062 friend class TagType;
2063
2064 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(KeywordWrapperBitfields)
2066
2067 /// Whether the TagType has a trailing Qualifier.
2068 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2069 unsigned HasQualifier : 1;
2070
2071 /// Whether the TagType owns the Tag.
2072 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2073 unsigned OwnsTag : 1;
2074
2075 /// Whether the TagType was created from an injected name.
2076 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2077 unsigned IsInjected : 1;
2078 };
2079
2081 friend class VectorType;
2083
2084 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2085 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2086
2087 /// The kind of vector, either a generic vector type or some
2088 /// target-specific vector type such as for AltiVec or Neon.
2089 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(VectorKind)
2090 unsigned VecKind : 4;
2091 /// The number of elements in the vector.
2092 uint32_t NumElements;
2093 };
2094
2096 friend class AttributedType;
2097
2098 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2099 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2100
2101 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(attr::Kind)
2102 unsigned AttrKind : 32 - NumTypeBits;
2103 };
2104
2106 friend class AutoType;
2107
2108 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2109 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2110
2111 /// Was this placeholder type spelled as 'auto', 'decltype(auto)',
2112 /// or '__auto_type'? AutoTypeKeyword value.
2113 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(AutoTypeKeyword)
2114 unsigned Keyword : 2;
2115
2116 /// The number of template arguments in the type-constraints, which is
2117 /// expected to be able to hold at least 1024 according to [implimits].
2118 /// However as this limit is somewhat easy to hit with template
2119 /// metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large as possible.
2120 /// At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since this type
2121 /// safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason to
2122 /// introduce the performance impact of a bitfield.
2123 unsigned NumArgs;
2124 };
2125
2127 friend class TypeOfType;
2128 friend class TypeOfExprType;
2129
2130 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2131 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2132 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeOfKind)
2133 unsigned Kind : 1;
2134 };
2135
2138
2139 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(KeywordWrapperBitfields)
2141
2142 /// True if there is a non-null qualifier.
2143 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2144 unsigned hasQualifier : 1;
2145 };
2146
2148 friend class UsingType;
2149
2150 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(KeywordWrapperBitfields)
2152
2153 /// True if there is a non-null qualifier.
2154 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2155 unsigned hasQualifier : 1;
2156 };
2157
2159 friend class TypedefType;
2160
2161 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(KeywordWrapperBitfields)
2163
2164 /// True if there is a non-null qualifier.
2165 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2166 unsigned hasQualifier : 1;
2167
2168 /// True if the underlying type is different from the declared one.
2169 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2170 unsigned hasTypeDifferentFromDecl : 1;
2171 };
2172
2175
2176 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2177 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2178
2179 /// The depth of the template parameter.
2180 unsigned Depth : 15;
2181
2182 /// Whether this is a template parameter pack.
2183 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2184 unsigned ParameterPack : 1;
2185
2186 /// The index of the template parameter.
2187 unsigned Index : 16;
2188 };
2189
2192
2193 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2194 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2195
2196 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2197 unsigned HasNonCanonicalUnderlyingType : 1;
2198
2199 // The index of the template parameter this substitution represents.
2200 unsigned Index : 15;
2201
2202 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2203 unsigned Final : 1;
2204
2205 /// Represents the index within a pack if this represents a substitution
2206 /// from a pack expansion. This index starts at the end of the pack and
2207 /// increments towards the beginning.
2208 /// Positive non-zero number represents the index + 1.
2209 /// Zero means this is not substituted from an expansion.
2210 unsigned PackIndex : 15;
2211 };
2212
2214 friend class SubstPackType;
2216
2217 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2218 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2219
2220 /// The number of template arguments in \c Arguments, which is
2221 /// expected to be able to hold at least 1024 according to [implimits].
2222 /// However as this limit is somewhat easy to hit with template
2223 /// metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large as possible.
2224 unsigned NumArgs : 16;
2225
2226 // The index of the template parameter this substitution represents.
2227 // Only used by SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType. We keep it in the same
2228 // class to avoid dealing with complexities of bitfields that go over
2229 // the size of `unsigned`.
2230 unsigned SubstTemplTypeParmPackIndex : 16;
2231 };
2232
2235
2236 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(KeywordWrapperBitfields)
2238
2239 /// Whether this template specialization type is a substituted type alias.
2240 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2241 unsigned TypeAlias : 1;
2242
2243 /// The number of template arguments named in this class template
2244 /// specialization, which is expected to be able to hold at least 1024
2245 /// according to [implimits]. However, as this limit is somewhat easy to
2246 /// hit with template metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large
2247 /// as possible. At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since
2248 /// this type safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason
2249 /// to introduce the performance impact of a bitfield.
2250 unsigned NumArgs;
2251 };
2252
2254 friend class PackExpansionType;
2255
2256 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2257 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2258
2259 /// The number of expansions that this pack expansion will
2260 /// generate when substituted (+1), which is expected to be able to
2261 /// hold at least 1024 according to [implimits]. However, as this limit
2262 /// is somewhat easy to hit with template metaprogramming we'd prefer to
2263 /// keep it as large as possible. At the moment it has been left as a
2264 /// non-bitfield since this type safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so
2265 /// there is no reason to introduce the performance impact of a bitfield.
2266 ///
2267 /// This field will only have a non-zero value when some of the parameter
2268 /// packs that occur within the pattern have been substituted but others
2269 /// have not.
2270 unsigned NumExpansions;
2271 };
2272
2274 /// The "size_t" type.
2276
2277 /// The signed integer type corresponding to "size_t".
2279
2280 /// The "ptrdiff_t" type.
2282
2283 // Indicates how many items the enum has.
2285 };
2286
2289
2290 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2291 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2292
2293 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(PredefinedSugarKind)
2294 unsigned Kind : 8;
2295 };
2296
2299
2300 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(TypeBitfields)
2301 unsigned : NumTypeBits;
2302
2303 static constexpr unsigned NumCoupledDeclsBits = 4;
2304 unsigned NumCoupledDecls : NumCoupledDeclsBits;
2305 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2306 unsigned CountInBytes : 1;
2307 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2308 unsigned OrNull : 1;
2309 };
2310 static_assert(sizeof(CountAttributedTypeBitfields) <= sizeof(unsigned));
2311
2312 union {
2313 TypeBitfields TypeBits;
2336 };
2337
2338private:
2339 template <class T> friend class TypePropertyCache;
2340
2341 /// Set whether this type comes from an AST file.
2342 void setFromAST(bool V = true) const {
2343 TypeBits.FromAST = V;
2344 }
2345
2346protected:
2347 friend class ASTContext;
2348
2350 : ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(this,
2351 canon.isNull() ? QualType(this_(), 0) : canon) {
2352 static_assert(sizeof(*this) <=
2353 alignof(decltype(*this)) + sizeof(ExtQualsTypeCommonBase),
2354 "changing bitfields changed sizeof(Type)!");
2355 static_assert(alignof(decltype(*this)) % TypeAlignment == 0,
2356 "Insufficient alignment!");
2357 TypeBits.TC = tc;
2358 TypeBits.Dependence = static_cast<unsigned>(Dependence);
2359 TypeBits.CacheValid = false;
2360 TypeBits.CachedLocalOrUnnamed = false;
2361 TypeBits.CachedLinkage = llvm::to_underlying(Linkage::Invalid);
2362 TypeBits.FromAST = false;
2363 }
2364
2365 // silence VC++ warning C4355: 'this' : used in base member initializer list
2366 Type *this_() { return this; }
2367
2369 TypeBits.Dependence = static_cast<unsigned>(D);
2370 }
2371
2373
2374public:
2375 friend class ASTReader;
2376 friend class ASTWriter;
2377 template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader;
2378 template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeWriter;
2379
2380 Type(const Type &) = delete;
2381 Type(Type &&) = delete;
2382 Type &operator=(const Type &) = delete;
2383 Type &operator=(Type &&) = delete;
2384
2385 TypeClass getTypeClass() const { return static_cast<TypeClass>(TypeBits.TC); }
2386
2387 /// Whether this type comes from an AST file.
2388 bool isFromAST() const { return TypeBits.FromAST; }
2389
2390 /// Whether this type is or contains an unexpanded parameter
2391 /// pack, used to support C++0x variadic templates.
2392 ///
2393 /// A type that contains a parameter pack shall be expanded by the
2394 /// ellipsis operator at some point. For example, the typedef in the
2395 /// following example contains an unexpanded parameter pack 'T':
2396 ///
2397 /// \code
2398 /// template<typename ...T>
2399 /// struct X {
2400 /// typedef T* pointer_types; // ill-formed; T is a parameter pack.
2401 /// };
2402 /// \endcode
2403 ///
2404 /// Note that this routine does not specify which
2406 return getDependence() & TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack;
2407 }
2408
2409 /// Determines if this type would be canonical if it had no further
2410 /// qualification.
2412 return CanonicalType == QualType(this, 0);
2413 }
2414
2415 /// Pull a single level of sugar off of this locally-unqualified type.
2416 /// Users should generally prefer SplitQualType::getSingleStepDesugaredType()
2417 /// or QualType::getSingleStepDesugaredType(const ASTContext&).
2418 QualType getLocallyUnqualifiedSingleStepDesugaredType() const;
2419
2420 /// As an extension, we classify types as one of "sized" or "sizeless";
2421 /// every type is one or the other. Standard types are all sized;
2422 /// sizeless types are purely an extension.
2423 ///
2424 /// Sizeless types contain data with no specified size, alignment,
2425 /// or layout.
2426 bool isSizelessType() const;
2427 bool isSizelessBuiltinType() const;
2428
2429 /// Returns true for all scalable vector types.
2430 bool isSizelessVectorType() const;
2431
2432 /// Returns true for SVE scalable vector types.
2433 bool isSVESizelessBuiltinType() const;
2434
2435 /// Returns true for RVV scalable vector types.
2436 bool isRVVSizelessBuiltinType() const;
2437
2438 /// Check if this is a WebAssembly Externref Type.
2439 bool isWebAssemblyExternrefType() const;
2440
2441 /// Returns true if this is a WebAssembly table type: either an array of
2442 /// reference types, or a pointer to a reference type (which can only be
2443 /// created by array to pointer decay).
2444 bool isWebAssemblyTableType() const;
2445
2446 /// Determines if this is a sizeless type supported by the
2447 /// 'arm_sve_vector_bits' type attribute, which can be applied to a single
2448 /// SVE vector or predicate, excluding tuple types such as svint32x4_t.
2449 bool isSveVLSBuiltinType() const;
2450
2451 /// Returns the representative type for the element of an SVE builtin type.
2452 /// This is used to represent fixed-length SVE vectors created with the
2453 /// 'arm_sve_vector_bits' type attribute as VectorType.
2454 QualType getSveEltType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2455
2456 /// Determines if this is a sizeless type supported by the
2457 /// 'riscv_rvv_vector_bits' type attribute, which can be applied to a single
2458 /// RVV vector or mask.
2459 bool isRVVVLSBuiltinType() const;
2460
2461 /// Returns the representative type for the element of an RVV builtin type.
2462 /// This is used to represent fixed-length RVV vectors created with the
2463 /// 'riscv_rvv_vector_bits' type attribute as VectorType.
2464 QualType getRVVEltType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2465
2466 /// Returns the representative type for the element of a sizeless vector
2467 /// builtin type.
2468 QualType getSizelessVectorEltType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2469
2470 /// Types are partitioned into 3 broad categories (C99 6.2.5p1):
2471 /// object types, function types, and incomplete types.
2472
2473 /// Return true if this is an incomplete type.
2474 /// A type that can describe objects, but which lacks information needed to
2475 /// determine its size (e.g. void, or a fwd declared struct). Clients of this
2476 /// routine will need to determine if the size is actually required.
2477 ///
2478 /// Def If non-null, and the type refers to some kind of declaration
2479 /// that can be completed (such as a C struct, C++ class, or Objective-C
2480 /// class), will be set to the declaration.
2481 bool isIncompleteType(NamedDecl **Def = nullptr) const;
2482
2483 /// Return true if this is an incomplete or object
2484 /// type, in other words, not a function type.
2486 return !isFunctionType();
2487 }
2488
2489 /// \returns True if the type is incomplete and it is also a type that
2490 /// cannot be completed by a later type definition.
2491 ///
2492 /// E.g. For `void` this is true but for `struct ForwardDecl;` this is false
2493 /// because a definition for `ForwardDecl` could be provided later on in the
2494 /// translation unit.
2495 ///
2496 /// Note even for types that this function returns true for it is still
2497 /// possible for the declarations that contain this type to later have a
2498 /// complete type in a translation unit. E.g.:
2499 ///
2500 /// \code{.c}
2501 /// // This decl has type 'char[]' which is incomplete and cannot be later
2502 /// // completed by another by another type declaration.
2503 /// extern char foo[];
2504 /// // This decl now has complete type 'char[5]'.
2505 /// char foo[5]; // foo has a complete type
2506 /// \endcode
2507 bool isAlwaysIncompleteType() const;
2508
2509 /// Determine whether this type is an object type.
2510 bool isObjectType() const {
2511 // C++ [basic.types]p8:
2512 // An object type is a (possibly cv-qualified) type that is not a
2513 // function type, not a reference type, and not a void type.
2514 return !isReferenceType() && !isFunctionType() && !isVoidType();
2515 }
2516
2517 /// Return true if this is a literal type
2518 /// (C++11 [basic.types]p10)
2519 bool isLiteralType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2520
2521 /// Determine if this type is a structural type, per C++20 [temp.param]p7.
2522 bool isStructuralType() const;
2523
2524 /// Test if this type is a standard-layout type.
2525 /// (C++0x [basic.type]p9)
2526 bool isStandardLayoutType() const;
2527
2528 /// Helper methods to distinguish type categories. All type predicates
2529 /// operate on the canonical type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers.
2530
2531 /// Returns true if the type is a builtin type.
2532 bool isBuiltinType() const;
2533
2534 /// Test for a particular builtin type.
2535 bool isSpecificBuiltinType(unsigned K) const;
2536
2537 /// Test for a type which does not represent an actual type-system type but
2538 /// is instead used as a placeholder for various convenient purposes within
2539 /// Clang. All such types are BuiltinTypes.
2540 bool isPlaceholderType() const;
2541 const BuiltinType *getAsPlaceholderType() const;
2542
2543 /// Test for a specific placeholder type.
2544 bool isSpecificPlaceholderType(unsigned K) const;
2545
2546 /// Test for a placeholder type other than Overload; see
2547 /// BuiltinType::isNonOverloadPlaceholderType.
2548 bool isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const;
2549
2550 /// isIntegerType() does *not* include complex integers (a GCC extension).
2551 /// isComplexIntegerType() can be used to test for complex integers.
2552 bool isIntegerType() const; // C99 6.2.5p17 (int, char, bool, enum)
2553 bool isEnumeralType() const;
2554
2555 /// Determine whether this type is a scoped enumeration type.
2556 bool isScopedEnumeralType() const;
2557 bool isBooleanType() const;
2558 bool isCharType() const;
2559 bool isWideCharType() const;
2560 bool isChar8Type() const;
2561 bool isChar16Type() const;
2562 bool isChar32Type() const;
2563 bool isAnyCharacterType() const;
2564 bool isUnicodeCharacterType() const;
2565 bool isIntegralType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2566
2567 /// Determine whether this type is an integral or enumeration type.
2568 bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType() const;
2569
2570 /// Determine whether this type is an integral or unscoped enumeration type.
2571 bool isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() const;
2572 bool isUnscopedEnumerationType() const;
2573
2574 /// Floating point categories.
2575 bool isRealFloatingType() const; // C99 6.2.5p10 (float, double, long double)
2576 /// isComplexType() does *not* include complex integers (a GCC extension).
2577 /// isComplexIntegerType() can be used to test for complex integers.
2578 bool isComplexType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (complex)
2579 bool isAnyComplexType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (complex) + Complex Int.
2580 bool isFloatingType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (real floating + complex)
2581 bool isHalfType() const; // OpenCL 6.1.1.1, NEON (IEEE 754-2008 half)
2582 bool isFloat16Type() const; // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661
2583 bool isFloat32Type() const;
2584 bool isDoubleType() const;
2585 bool isBFloat16Type() const;
2586 bool isMFloat8Type() const;
2587 bool isFloat128Type() const;
2588 bool isIbm128Type() const;
2589 bool isRealType() const; // C99 6.2.5p17 (real floating + integer)
2590 bool isArithmeticType() const; // C99 6.2.5p18 (integer + floating)
2591 bool isVoidType() const; // C99 6.2.5p19
2592 bool isScalarType() const; // C99 6.2.5p21 (arithmetic + pointers)
2593 bool isAggregateType() const;
2594 bool isFundamentalType() const;
2595 bool isCompoundType() const;
2596
2597 // Type Predicates: Check to see if this type is structurally the specified
2598 // type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers.
2599 bool isFunctionType() const;
2602 bool isPointerType() const;
2603 bool isPointerOrReferenceType() const;
2604 bool isSignableType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2605 bool isSignablePointerType() const;
2606 bool isSignableIntegerType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
2607 bool isAnyPointerType() const; // Any C pointer or ObjC object pointer
2608 bool isCountAttributedType() const;
2609 bool isCFIUncheckedCalleeFunctionType() const;
2610 bool hasPointeeToToCFIUncheckedCalleeFunctionType() const;
2611 bool isBlockPointerType() const;
2612 bool isVoidPointerType() const;
2613 bool isReferenceType() const;
2614 bool isLValueReferenceType() const;
2615 bool isRValueReferenceType() const;
2616 bool isObjectPointerType() const;
2617 bool isFunctionPointerType() const;
2618 bool isFunctionReferenceType() const;
2619 bool isMemberPointerType() const;
2620 bool isMemberFunctionPointerType() const;
2621 bool isMemberDataPointerType() const;
2622 bool isArrayType() const;
2623 bool isConstantArrayType() const;
2624 bool isIncompleteArrayType() const;
2625 bool isVariableArrayType() const;
2626 bool isArrayParameterType() const;
2627 bool isDependentSizedArrayType() const;
2628 bool isRecordType() const;
2629 bool isClassType() const;
2630 bool isStructureType() const;
2631 bool isStructureTypeWithFlexibleArrayMember() const;
2632 bool isObjCBoxableRecordType() const;
2633 bool isInterfaceType() const;
2634 bool isStructureOrClassType() const;
2635 bool isUnionType() const;
2636 bool isComplexIntegerType() const; // GCC _Complex integer type.
2637 bool isVectorType() const; // GCC vector type.
2638 bool isExtVectorType() const; // Extended vector type.
2639 bool isExtVectorBoolType() const; // Extended vector type with bool element.
2640 // Extended vector type with bool element that is packed. HLSL doesn't pack
2641 // its bool vectors.
2642 bool isPackedVectorBoolType(const ASTContext &ctx) const;
2643 bool isSubscriptableVectorType() const;
2644 bool isMatrixType() const; // Matrix type.
2645 bool isConstantMatrixType() const; // Constant matrix type.
2646 bool isDependentAddressSpaceType() const; // value-dependent address space qualifier
2647 bool isObjCObjectPointerType() const; // pointer to ObjC object
2648 bool isObjCRetainableType() const; // ObjC object or block pointer
2649 bool isObjCLifetimeType() const; // (array of)* retainable type
2650 bool isObjCIndirectLifetimeType() const; // (pointer to)* lifetime type
2651 bool isObjCNSObjectType() const; // __attribute__((NSObject))
2652 bool isObjCIndependentClassType() const; // __attribute__((objc_independent_class))
2653 // FIXME: change this to 'raw' interface type, so we can used 'interface' type
2654 // for the common case.
2655 bool isObjCObjectType() const; // NSString or typeof(*(id)0)
2656 bool isObjCQualifiedInterfaceType() const; // NSString<foo>
2657 bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const; // id<foo>
2658 bool isObjCQualifiedClassType() const; // Class<foo>
2659 bool isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() const;
2660 bool isObjCIdType() const; // id
2661 bool isDecltypeType() const;
2662 /// Was this type written with the special inert-in-ARC __unsafe_unretained
2663 /// qualifier?
2664 ///
2665 /// This approximates the answer to the following question: if this
2666 /// translation unit were compiled in ARC, would this type be qualified
2667 /// with __unsafe_unretained?
2669 return hasAttr(attr::ObjCInertUnsafeUnretained);
2670 }
2671
2672 /// Whether the type is Objective-C 'id' or a __kindof type of an
2673 /// object type, e.g., __kindof NSView * or __kindof id
2674 /// <NSCopying>.
2675 ///
2676 /// \param bound Will be set to the bound on non-id subtype types,
2677 /// which will be (possibly specialized) Objective-C class type, or
2678 /// null for 'id.
2679 bool isObjCIdOrObjectKindOfType(const ASTContext &ctx,
2680 const ObjCObjectType *&bound) const;
2681
2682 bool isObjCClassType() const; // Class
2683
2684 /// Whether the type is Objective-C 'Class' or a __kindof type of an
2685 /// Class type, e.g., __kindof Class <NSCopying>.
2686 ///
2687 /// Unlike \c isObjCIdOrObjectKindOfType, there is no relevant bound
2688 /// here because Objective-C's type system cannot express "a class
2689 /// object for a subclass of NSFoo".
2690 bool isObjCClassOrClassKindOfType() const;
2691
2692 bool isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(ASTContext &ctx) const;
2693 bool isObjCSelType() const; // Class
2694 bool isObjCBuiltinType() const; // 'id' or 'Class'
2695 bool isObjCARCBridgableType() const;
2696 bool isCARCBridgableType() const;
2697 bool isTemplateTypeParmType() const; // C++ template type parameter
2698 bool isNullPtrType() const; // C++11 std::nullptr_t or
2699 // C23 nullptr_t
2700 bool isNothrowT() const; // C++ std::nothrow_t
2701 bool isAlignValT() const; // C++17 std::align_val_t
2702 bool isStdByteType() const; // C++17 std::byte
2703 bool isAtomicType() const; // C11 _Atomic()
2704 bool isUndeducedAutoType() const; // C++11 auto or
2705 // C++14 decltype(auto)
2706 bool isTypedefNameType() const; // typedef or alias template
2707
2708#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
2709 bool is##Id##Type() const;
2710#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
2711
2712 bool isImageType() const; // Any OpenCL image type
2713
2714 bool isSamplerT() const; // OpenCL sampler_t
2715 bool isEventT() const; // OpenCL event_t
2716 bool isClkEventT() const; // OpenCL clk_event_t
2717 bool isQueueT() const; // OpenCL queue_t
2718 bool isReserveIDT() const; // OpenCL reserve_id_t
2719
2720#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
2721 bool is##Id##Type() const;
2722#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
2723 // Type defined in cl_intel_device_side_avc_motion_estimation OpenCL extension
2724 bool isOCLIntelSubgroupAVCType() const;
2725 bool isOCLExtOpaqueType() const; // Any OpenCL extension type
2726
2727 bool isPipeType() const; // OpenCL pipe type
2728 bool isBitIntType() const; // Bit-precise integer type
2729 bool isOpenCLSpecificType() const; // Any OpenCL specific type
2730
2731#define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) bool is##Id##Type() const;
2732#include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
2733 bool isHLSLSpecificType() const; // Any HLSL specific type
2734 bool isHLSLBuiltinIntangibleType() const; // Any HLSL builtin intangible type
2735 bool isHLSLAttributedResourceType() const;
2736 bool isHLSLInlineSpirvType() const;
2737 bool isHLSLResourceRecord() const;
2738 bool isHLSLResourceRecordArray() const;
2739 bool isHLSLIntangibleType()
2740 const; // Any HLSL intangible type (builtin, array, class)
2741
2742 /// Determines if this type, which must satisfy
2743 /// isObjCLifetimeType(), is implicitly __unsafe_unretained rather
2744 /// than implicitly __strong.
2745 bool isObjCARCImplicitlyUnretainedType() const;
2746
2747 /// Check if the type is the CUDA device builtin surface type.
2748 bool isCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceType() const;
2749 /// Check if the type is the CUDA device builtin texture type.
2750 bool isCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureType() const;
2751
2752 /// Return the implicit lifetime for this type, which must not be dependent.
2753 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCARCImplicitLifetime() const;
2754
2767
2768 /// Given that this is a scalar type, classify it.
2769 ScalarTypeKind getScalarTypeKind() const;
2770
2772 return static_cast<TypeDependence>(TypeBits.Dependence);
2773 }
2774
2775 /// Whether this type is an error type.
2776 bool containsErrors() const {
2777 return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Error;
2778 }
2779
2780 /// Whether this type is a dependent type, meaning that its definition
2781 /// somehow depends on a template parameter (C++ [temp.dep.type]).
2782 bool isDependentType() const {
2783 return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Dependent;
2784 }
2785
2786 /// Determine whether this type is an instantiation-dependent type,
2787 /// meaning that the type involves a template parameter (even if the
2788 /// definition does not actually depend on the type substituted for that
2789 /// template parameter).
2791 return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Instantiation;
2792 }
2793
2794 /// Determine whether this type is an undeduced type, meaning that
2795 /// it somehow involves a C++11 'auto' type or similar which has not yet been
2796 /// deduced.
2797 bool isUndeducedType() const;
2798
2799 /// Whether this type is a variably-modified type (C99 6.7.5).
2801 return getDependence() & TypeDependence::VariablyModified;
2802 }
2803
2804 /// Whether this type involves a variable-length array type
2805 /// with a definite size.
2806 bool hasSizedVLAType() const;
2807
2808 /// Whether this type is or contains a local or unnamed type.
2809 bool hasUnnamedOrLocalType() const;
2810
2811 bool isOverloadableType() const;
2812
2813 /// Determine wither this type is a C++ elaborated-type-specifier.
2814 bool isElaboratedTypeSpecifier() const;
2815
2816 bool canDecayToPointerType() const;
2817
2818 /// Whether this type is represented natively as a pointer. This includes
2819 /// pointers, references, block pointers, and Objective-C interface,
2820 /// qualified id, and qualified interface types, as well as nullptr_t.
2821 bool hasPointerRepresentation() const;
2822
2823 /// Whether this type can represent an objective pointer type for the
2824 /// purpose of GC'ability
2825 bool hasObjCPointerRepresentation() const;
2826
2827 /// Determine whether this type has an integer representation
2828 /// of some sort, e.g., it is an integer type or a vector.
2829 bool hasIntegerRepresentation() const;
2830
2831 /// Determine whether this type has an signed integer representation
2832 /// of some sort, e.g., it is an signed integer type or a vector.
2833 bool hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() const;
2834
2835 /// Determine whether this type has an unsigned integer representation
2836 /// of some sort, e.g., it is an unsigned integer type or a vector.
2837 bool hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() const;
2838
2839 /// Determine whether this type has a floating-point representation
2840 /// of some sort, e.g., it is a floating-point type or a vector thereof.
2841 bool hasFloatingRepresentation() const;
2842
2843 /// Determine whether this type has a boolean representation -- i.e., it is a
2844 /// boolean type, an enum type whose underlying type is a boolean type, or a
2845 /// vector of booleans.
2846 bool hasBooleanRepresentation() const;
2847
2848 // Type Checking Functions: Check to see if this type is structurally the
2849 // specified type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers, and return a pointer to
2850 // the best type we can.
2851 const RecordType *getAsStructureType() const;
2852 /// NOTE: getAs*ArrayType are methods on ASTContext.
2853 const RecordType *getAsUnionType() const;
2854 const ComplexType *getAsComplexIntegerType() const; // GCC complex int type.
2855 const ObjCObjectType *getAsObjCInterfaceType() const;
2856
2857 // The following is a convenience method that returns an ObjCObjectPointerType
2858 // for object declared using an interface.
2859 const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCInterfacePointerType() const;
2860 const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCQualifiedIdType() const;
2861 const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCQualifiedClassType() const;
2862 const ObjCObjectType *getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType() const;
2863
2864 /// Retrieves the CXXRecordDecl that this type refers to, either
2865 /// because the type is a RecordType or because it is the injected-class-name
2866 /// type of a class template or class template partial specialization.
2867 inline CXXRecordDecl *getAsCXXRecordDecl() const;
2868 inline CXXRecordDecl *castAsCXXRecordDecl() const;
2869
2870 /// Retrieves the RecordDecl this type refers to.
2871 inline RecordDecl *getAsRecordDecl() const;
2872 inline RecordDecl *castAsRecordDecl() const;
2873
2874 /// Retrieves the EnumDecl this type refers to.
2875 inline EnumDecl *getAsEnumDecl() const;
2876 inline EnumDecl *castAsEnumDecl() const;
2877
2878 /// Retrieves the TagDecl that this type refers to, either
2879 /// because the type is a TagType or because it is the injected-class-name
2880 /// type of a class template or class template partial specialization.
2881 inline TagDecl *getAsTagDecl() const;
2882 inline TagDecl *castAsTagDecl() const;
2883
2884 /// If this is a pointer or reference to a RecordType, return the
2885 /// CXXRecordDecl that the type refers to.
2886 ///
2887 /// If this is not a pointer or reference, or the type being pointed to does
2888 /// not refer to a CXXRecordDecl, returns NULL.
2889 const CXXRecordDecl *getPointeeCXXRecordDecl() const;
2890
2891 /// Get the DeducedType whose type will be deduced for a variable with
2892 /// an initializer of this type. This looks through declarators like pointer
2893 /// types, but not through decltype or typedefs.
2894 DeducedType *getContainedDeducedType() const;
2895
2896 /// Get the AutoType whose type will be deduced for a variable with
2897 /// an initializer of this type. This looks through declarators like pointer
2898 /// types, but not through decltype or typedefs.
2899 AutoType *getContainedAutoType() const {
2900 return dyn_cast_or_null<AutoType>(getContainedDeducedType());
2901 }
2902
2903 /// Determine whether this type was written with a leading 'auto'
2904 /// corresponding to a trailing return type (possibly for a nested
2905 /// function type within a pointer to function type or similar).
2906 bool hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() const;
2907
2908 /// Member-template getAs<specific type>'. Look through sugar for
2909 /// an instance of <specific type>. This scheme will eventually
2910 /// replace the specific getAsXXXX methods above.
2911 ///
2912 /// There are some specializations of this member template listed
2913 /// immediately following this class.
2914 ///
2915 /// If you are interested only in the canonical properties of this type,
2916 /// consider using getAsCanonical instead, as that is much faster.
2917 template <typename T> const T *getAs() const;
2918
2919 /// If this type is canonically the specified type, return its canonical type
2920 /// cast to that specified type, otherwise returns null.
2921 template <typename T> const T *getAsCanonical() const {
2922 return dyn_cast<T>(CanonicalType);
2923 }
2924
2925 /// Return this type's canonical type cast to the specified type.
2926 /// If the type is not canonically that specified type, the behaviour is
2927 /// undefined.
2928 template <typename T> const T *castAsCanonical() const {
2929 return cast<T>(CanonicalType);
2930 }
2931
2932// It is not helpful to use these on types which are never canonical
2933#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2934#define NEVER_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class) \
2935 template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::getAsCanonical() const = delete; \
2936 template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::castAsCanonical() const = delete;
2937#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
2938
2939 /// Look through sugar for an instance of TemplateSpecializationType which
2940 /// is not a type alias, or null if there is no such type.
2941 /// This is used when you want as-written template arguments or the template
2942 /// name for a class template specialization.
2943 const TemplateSpecializationType *
2944 getAsNonAliasTemplateSpecializationType() const;
2945
2946 const TemplateSpecializationType *
2948 const auto *TST = getAsNonAliasTemplateSpecializationType();
2949 assert(TST && "not a TemplateSpecializationType");
2950 return TST;
2951 }
2952
2953 /// Member-template getAsAdjusted<specific type>. Look through specific kinds
2954 /// of sugar (parens, attributes, etc) for an instance of <specific type>.
2955 /// This is used when you need to walk over sugar nodes that represent some
2956 /// kind of type adjustment from a type that was written as a <specific type>
2957 /// to another type that is still canonically a <specific type>.
2958 template <typename T> const T *getAsAdjusted() const;
2959
2960 /// A variant of getAs<> for array types which silently discards
2961 /// qualifiers from the outermost type.
2962 const ArrayType *getAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const;
2963
2964 /// Member-template castAs<specific type>. Look through sugar for
2965 /// the underlying instance of <specific type>.
2966 ///
2967 /// This method has the same relationship to getAs<T> as cast<T> has
2968 /// to dyn_cast<T>; which is to say, the underlying type *must*
2969 /// have the intended type, and this method will never return null.
2970 template <typename T> const T *castAs() const;
2971
2972 /// A variant of castAs<> for array type which silently discards
2973 /// qualifiers from the outermost type.
2974 const ArrayType *castAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const;
2975
2976 /// If this type represents a qualified-id, this returns its nested name
2977 /// specifier. For example, for the qualified-id "foo::bar::baz", this returns
2978 /// "foo::bar". Returns null if this type represents an unqualified-id.
2979 NestedNameSpecifier getPrefix() const;
2980
2981 /// Determine whether this type had the specified attribute applied to it
2982 /// (looking through top-level type sugar).
2983 bool hasAttr(attr::Kind AK) const;
2984
2985 /// Get the base element type of this type, potentially discarding type
2986 /// qualifiers. This should never be used when type qualifiers
2987 /// are meaningful.
2988 const Type *getBaseElementTypeUnsafe() const;
2989
2990 /// If this is an array type, return the element type of the array,
2991 /// potentially with type qualifiers missing.
2992 /// This should never be used when type qualifiers are meaningful.
2993 const Type *getArrayElementTypeNoTypeQual() const;
2994
2995 /// If this is a pointer type, return the pointee type.
2996 /// If this is an array type, return the array element type.
2997 /// This should never be used when type qualifiers are meaningful.
2998 const Type *getPointeeOrArrayElementType() const;
2999
3000 /// If this is a pointer, ObjC object pointer, or block
3001 /// pointer, this returns the respective pointee.
3002 QualType getPointeeType() const;
3003
3004 /// Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from the type,
3005 /// removing any typedefs, typeofs, etc., as well as any qualifiers.
3006 const Type *getUnqualifiedDesugaredType() const;
3007
3008 /// Return true if this is an integer type that is
3009 /// signed, according to C99 6.2.5p4 [char, signed char, short, int, long..],
3010 /// or an enum decl which has a signed representation.
3011 bool isSignedIntegerType() const;
3012
3013 /// Return true if this is an integer type that is
3014 /// unsigned, according to C99 6.2.5p6 [which returns true for _Bool],
3015 /// or an enum decl which has an unsigned representation.
3016 bool isUnsignedIntegerType() const;
3017
3018 /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is signed or an
3019 /// enumeration types whose underlying type is a signed integer type.
3020 bool isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const;
3021
3022 /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is unsigned or an
3023 /// enumeration types whose underlying type is a unsigned integer type.
3024 bool isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const;
3025
3026 /// Return true if this is a fixed point type according to
3027 /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
3028 bool isFixedPointType() const;
3029
3030 /// Return true if this is a fixed point or integer type.
3031 bool isFixedPointOrIntegerType() const;
3032
3033 /// Return true if this can be converted to (or from) a fixed point type.
3034 bool isConvertibleToFixedPointType() const;
3035
3036 /// Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to
3037 /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can be signed or unsigned.
3038 bool isSaturatedFixedPointType() const;
3039
3040 /// Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to
3041 /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can be signed or unsigned.
3042 bool isUnsaturatedFixedPointType() const;
3043
3044 /// Return true if this is a fixed point type that is signed according
3045 /// to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can also be saturated.
3046 bool isSignedFixedPointType() const;
3047
3048 /// Return true if this is a fixed point type that is unsigned according
3049 /// to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can also be saturated.
3050 bool isUnsignedFixedPointType() const;
3051
3052 /// Return true if this is not a variable sized type,
3053 /// according to the rules of C99 6.7.5p3. It is not legal to call this on
3054 /// incomplete types.
3055 bool isConstantSizeType() const;
3056
3057 /// Returns true if this type can be represented by some
3058 /// set of type specifiers.
3059 bool isSpecifierType() const;
3060
3061 /// Determine the linkage of this type.
3062 Linkage getLinkage() const;
3063
3064 /// Determine the visibility of this type.
3066 return getLinkageAndVisibility().getVisibility();
3067 }
3068
3069 /// Return true if the visibility was explicitly set is the code.
3071 return getLinkageAndVisibility().isVisibilityExplicit();
3072 }
3073
3074 /// Determine the linkage and visibility of this type.
3075 LinkageInfo getLinkageAndVisibility() const;
3076
3077 /// True if the computed linkage is valid. Used for consistency
3078 /// checking. Should always return true.
3079 bool isLinkageValid() const;
3080
3081 /// Determine the nullability of the given type.
3082 ///
3083 /// Note that nullability is only captured as sugar within the type
3084 /// system, not as part of the canonical type, so nullability will
3085 /// be lost by canonicalization and desugaring.
3086 std::optional<NullabilityKind> getNullability() const;
3087
3088 /// Determine whether the given type can have a nullability
3089 /// specifier applied to it, i.e., if it is any kind of pointer type.
3090 ///
3091 /// \param ResultIfUnknown The value to return if we don't yet know whether
3092 /// this type can have nullability because it is dependent.
3093 bool canHaveNullability(bool ResultIfUnknown = true) const;
3094
3095 /// Retrieve the set of substitutions required when accessing a member
3096 /// of the Objective-C receiver type that is declared in the given context.
3097 ///
3098 /// \c *this is the type of the object we're operating on, e.g., the
3099 /// receiver for a message send or the base of a property access, and is
3100 /// expected to be of some object or object pointer type.
3101 ///
3102 /// \param dc The declaration context for which we are building up a
3103 /// substitution mapping, which should be an Objective-C class, extension,
3104 /// category, or method within.
3105 ///
3106 /// \returns an array of type arguments that can be substituted for
3107 /// the type parameters of the given declaration context in any type described
3108 /// within that context, or an empty optional to indicate that no
3109 /// substitution is required.
3110 std::optional<ArrayRef<QualType>>
3111 getObjCSubstitutions(const DeclContext *dc) const;
3112
3113 /// Determines if this is an ObjC interface type that may accept type
3114 /// parameters.
3115 bool acceptsObjCTypeParams() const;
3116
3117 const char *getTypeClassName() const;
3118
3120 return CanonicalType;
3121 }
3122
3123 CanQualType getCanonicalTypeUnqualified() const; // in CanonicalType.h
3124 void dump() const;
3125 void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS, const ASTContext &Context) const;
3126};
3127
3128/// This will check for a TypedefType by removing any existing sugar
3129/// until it reaches a TypedefType or a non-sugared type.
3130template <> const TypedefType *Type::getAs() const;
3131template <> const UsingType *Type::getAs() const;
3132
3133/// This will check for a TemplateSpecializationType by removing any
3134/// existing sugar until it reaches a TemplateSpecializationType or a
3135/// non-sugared type.
3136template <> const TemplateSpecializationType *Type::getAs() const;
3137
3138/// This will check for an AttributedType by removing any existing sugar
3139/// until it reaches an AttributedType or a non-sugared type.
3140template <> const AttributedType *Type::getAs() const;
3141
3142/// This will check for a BoundsAttributedType by removing any existing
3143/// sugar until it reaches an BoundsAttributedType or a non-sugared type.
3144template <> const BoundsAttributedType *Type::getAs() const;
3145
3146/// This will check for a CountAttributedType by removing any existing
3147/// sugar until it reaches an CountAttributedType or a non-sugared type.
3148template <> const CountAttributedType *Type::getAs() const;
3149
3150// We can do always canonical types faster, because we don't have to
3151// worry about preserving decoration.
3152#define TYPE(Class, Base)
3153#define ALWAYS_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class) \
3154 template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::getAs() const { \
3155 return dyn_cast<Class##Type>(CanonicalType); \
3156 } \
3157 template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::castAs() const { \
3158 return cast<Class##Type>(CanonicalType); \
3159 }
3160#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
3161
3162/// This class is used for builtin types like 'int'. Builtin
3163/// types are always canonical and have a literal name field.
3164class BuiltinType : public Type {
3165public:
3166 enum Kind {
3167// OpenCL image types
3168#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) Id,
3169#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
3170// OpenCL extension types
3171#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) Id,
3172#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
3173// SVE Types
3174#define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id,
3175#include "clang/Basic/AArch64ACLETypes.def"
3176// PPC MMA Types
3177#define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) Id,
3178#include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
3179// RVV Types
3180#define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id,
3181#include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
3182// WebAssembly reference types
3183#define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id,
3184#include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
3185// AMDGPU types
3186#define AMDGPU_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, Width, Align) Id,
3187#include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
3188// HLSL intangible Types
3189#define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id,
3190#include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
3191// All other builtin types
3192#define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) Id,
3193#define LAST_BUILTIN_TYPE(Id) LastKind = Id
3194#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
3195 };
3196
3197private:
3198 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3199
3200 BuiltinType(Kind K)
3201 : Type(Builtin, QualType(),
3202 K == Dependent ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation
3203 : TypeDependence::None) {
3204 static_assert(Kind::LastKind <
3205 (1 << BuiltinTypeBitfields::NumOfBuiltinTypeBits) &&
3206 "Defined builtin type exceeds the allocated space for serial "
3207 "numbering");
3208 BuiltinTypeBits.Kind = K;
3209 }
3210
3211public:
3212 Kind getKind() const { return static_cast<Kind>(BuiltinTypeBits.Kind); }
3213 StringRef getName(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
3214
3215 const char *getNameAsCString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const {
3216 // The StringRef is null-terminated.
3217 StringRef str = getName(Policy);
3218 assert(!str.empty() && str.data()[str.size()] == '\0');
3219 return str.data();
3220 }
3221
3222 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3223 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3224
3225 bool isInteger() const {
3226 return getKind() >= Bool && getKind() <= Int128;
3227 }
3228
3229 bool isSignedInteger() const {
3230 return getKind() >= Char_S && getKind() <= Int128;
3231 }
3232
3233 bool isUnsignedInteger() const {
3234 return getKind() >= Bool && getKind() <= UInt128;
3235 }
3236
3237 bool isFloatingPoint() const {
3238 return getKind() >= Half && getKind() <= Ibm128;
3239 }
3240
3241 bool isSVEBool() const { return getKind() == Kind::SveBool; }
3242
3243 bool isSVECount() const { return getKind() == Kind::SveCount; }
3244
3245 /// Determines whether the given kind corresponds to a placeholder type.
3247 return K >= Overload;
3248 }
3249
3250 /// Determines whether this type is a placeholder type, i.e. a type
3251 /// which cannot appear in arbitrary positions in a fully-formed
3252 /// expression.
3253 bool isPlaceholderType() const {
3255 }
3256
3257 /// Determines whether this type is a placeholder type other than
3258 /// Overload. Most placeholder types require only syntactic
3259 /// information about their context in order to be resolved (e.g.
3260 /// whether it is a call expression), which means they can (and
3261 /// should) be resolved in an earlier "phase" of analysis.
3262 /// Overload expressions sometimes pick up further information
3263 /// from their context, like whether the context expects a
3264 /// specific function-pointer type, and so frequently need
3265 /// special treatment.
3267 return getKind() > Overload;
3268 }
3269
3270 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Builtin; }
3271};
3272
3273/// Complex values, per C99 6.2.5p11. This supports the C99 complex
3274/// types (_Complex float etc) as well as the GCC integer complex extensions.
3275class ComplexType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3276 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3277
3278 QualType ElementType;
3279
3280 ComplexType(QualType Element, QualType CanonicalPtr)
3281 : Type(Complex, CanonicalPtr, Element->getDependence()),
3282 ElementType(Element) {}
3283
3284public:
3285 QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
3286
3287 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3288 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3289
3290 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3291 Profile(ID, getElementType());
3292 }
3293
3294 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Element) {
3295 ID.AddPointer(Element.getAsOpaquePtr());
3296 }
3297
3298 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Complex; }
3299};
3300
3301/// Sugar for parentheses used when specifying types.
3302class ParenType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3303 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3304
3305 QualType Inner;
3306
3307 ParenType(QualType InnerType, QualType CanonType)
3308 : Type(Paren, CanonType, InnerType->getDependence()), Inner(InnerType) {}
3309
3310public:
3311 QualType getInnerType() const { return Inner; }
3312
3313 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
3314 QualType desugar() const { return getInnerType(); }
3315
3316 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3317 Profile(ID, getInnerType());
3318 }
3319
3320 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Inner) {
3321 Inner.Profile(ID);
3322 }
3323
3324 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Paren; }
3325};
3326
3327/// PointerType - C99 6.7.5.1 - Pointer Declarators.
3328class PointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3329 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3330
3331 QualType PointeeType;
3332
3333 PointerType(QualType Pointee, QualType CanonicalPtr)
3334 : Type(Pointer, CanonicalPtr, Pointee->getDependence()),
3335 PointeeType(Pointee) {}
3336
3337public:
3338 QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
3339
3340 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3341 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3342
3343 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3344 Profile(ID, getPointeeType());
3345 }
3346
3347 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee) {
3348 ID.AddPointer(Pointee.getAsOpaquePtr());
3349 }
3350
3351 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Pointer; }
3352};
3353
3354/// [BoundsSafety] Represents information of declarations referenced by the
3355/// arguments of the `counted_by` attribute and the likes.
3357public:
3358 using BaseTy = llvm::PointerIntPair<ValueDecl *, 1, unsigned>;
3359
3360private:
3361 enum {
3362 DerefShift = 0,
3363 DerefMask = 1,
3364 };
3365 BaseTy Data;
3366
3367public:
3368 /// \p D is to a declaration referenced by the argument of attribute. \p Deref
3369 /// indicates whether \p D is referenced as a dereferenced form, e.g., \p
3370 /// Deref is true for `*n` in `int *__counted_by(*n)`.
3371 TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo(ValueDecl *D = nullptr, bool Deref = false);
3372
3373 bool isDeref() const;
3374 ValueDecl *getDecl() const;
3375 unsigned getInt() const;
3376 void *getOpaqueValue() const;
3377 bool operator==(const TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo &Other) const;
3378 void setFromOpaqueValue(void *V);
3379};
3380
3381/// [BoundsSafety] Represents a parent type class for CountAttributedType and
3382/// similar sugar types that will be introduced to represent a type with a
3383/// bounds attribute.
3384///
3385/// Provides a common interface to navigate declarations referred to by the
3386/// bounds expression.
3387
3388class BoundsAttributedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3389 QualType WrappedTy;
3390
3391protected:
3392 ArrayRef<TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo> Decls; // stored in trailing objects
3393
3394 BoundsAttributedType(TypeClass TC, QualType Wrapped, QualType Canon);
3395
3396public:
3397 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
3398 QualType desugar() const { return WrappedTy; }
3399
3401 using decl_range = llvm::iterator_range<decl_iterator>;
3402
3403 decl_iterator dependent_decl_begin() const { return Decls.begin(); }
3404 decl_iterator dependent_decl_end() const { return Decls.end(); }
3405
3406 unsigned getNumCoupledDecls() const { return Decls.size(); }
3407
3411
3415
3416 bool referencesFieldDecls() const;
3417
3418 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3419 // Currently, only `class CountAttributedType` inherits
3420 // `BoundsAttributedType` but the subclass will grow as we add more bounds
3421 // annotations.
3422 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
3423 case CountAttributed:
3424 return true;
3425 default:
3426 return false;
3427 }
3428 }
3429};
3430
3431/// Represents a sugar type with `__counted_by` or `__sized_by` annotations,
3432/// including their `_or_null` variants.
3433class CountAttributedType final
3434 : public BoundsAttributedType,
3435 public llvm::TrailingObjects<CountAttributedType,
3436 TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo> {
3437 friend class ASTContext;
3438
3439 Expr *CountExpr;
3440 /// \p CountExpr represents the argument of __counted_by or the likes. \p
3441 /// CountInBytes indicates that \p CountExpr is a byte count (i.e.,
3442 /// __sized_by(_or_null)) \p OrNull means it's an or_null variant (i.e.,
3443 /// __counted_by_or_null or __sized_by_or_null) \p CoupledDecls contains the
3444 /// list of declarations referenced by \p CountExpr, which the type depends on
3445 /// for the bounds information.
3446 CountAttributedType(QualType Wrapped, QualType Canon, Expr *CountExpr,
3447 bool CountInBytes, bool OrNull,
3449
3450 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo>) const {
3451 return CountAttributedTypeBits.NumCoupledDecls;
3452 }
3453
3454public:
3461
3462 Expr *getCountExpr() const { return CountExpr; }
3463 bool isCountInBytes() const { return CountAttributedTypeBits.CountInBytes; }
3464 bool isOrNull() const { return CountAttributedTypeBits.OrNull; }
3465
3467 if (isOrNull())
3469 return isCountInBytes() ? SizedBy : CountedBy;
3470 }
3471
3472 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3473 Profile(ID, desugar(), CountExpr, isCountInBytes(), isOrNull());
3474 }
3475
3476 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType WrappedTy,
3477 Expr *CountExpr, bool CountInBytes, bool Nullable);
3478
3479 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3480 return T->getTypeClass() == CountAttributed;
3481 }
3482
3483 StringRef getAttributeName(bool WithMacroPrefix) const;
3484};
3485
3486/// Represents a type which was implicitly adjusted by the semantic
3487/// engine for arbitrary reasons. For example, array and function types can
3488/// decay, and function types can have their calling conventions adjusted.
3489class AdjustedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3490 QualType OriginalTy;
3491 QualType AdjustedTy;
3492
3493protected:
3494 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3495
3496 AdjustedType(TypeClass TC, QualType OriginalTy, QualType AdjustedTy,
3497 QualType CanonicalPtr)
3498 : Type(TC, CanonicalPtr, OriginalTy->getDependence()),
3499 OriginalTy(OriginalTy), AdjustedTy(AdjustedTy) {}
3500
3501public:
3502 QualType getOriginalType() const { return OriginalTy; }
3503 QualType getAdjustedType() const { return AdjustedTy; }
3504
3505 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
3506 QualType desugar() const { return AdjustedTy; }
3507
3508 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3509 Profile(ID, OriginalTy, AdjustedTy);
3510 }
3511
3512 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Orig, QualType New) {
3513 ID.AddPointer(Orig.getAsOpaquePtr());
3514 ID.AddPointer(New.getAsOpaquePtr());
3515 }
3516
3517 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3518 return T->getTypeClass() == Adjusted || T->getTypeClass() == Decayed;
3519 }
3520};
3521
3522/// Represents a pointer type decayed from an array or function type.
3523class DecayedType : public AdjustedType {
3524 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3525
3526 inline
3527 DecayedType(QualType OriginalType, QualType Decayed, QualType Canonical);
3528
3529public:
3531
3532 inline QualType getPointeeType() const;
3533
3534 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Decayed; }
3535};
3536
3537/// Pointer to a block type.
3538/// This type is to represent types syntactically represented as
3539/// "void (^)(int)", etc. Pointee is required to always be a function type.
3540class BlockPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3541 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3542
3543 // Block is some kind of pointer type
3544 QualType PointeeType;
3545
3546 BlockPointerType(QualType Pointee, QualType CanonicalCls)
3547 : Type(BlockPointer, CanonicalCls, Pointee->getDependence()),
3548 PointeeType(Pointee) {}
3549
3550public:
3551 // Get the pointee type. Pointee is required to always be a function type.
3552 QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
3553
3554 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3555 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3556
3557 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3558 Profile(ID, getPointeeType());
3559 }
3560
3561 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee) {
3562 ID.AddPointer(Pointee.getAsOpaquePtr());
3563 }
3564
3565 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3566 return T->getTypeClass() == BlockPointer;
3567 }
3568};
3569
3570/// Base for LValueReferenceType and RValueReferenceType
3571class ReferenceType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3572 QualType PointeeType;
3573
3574protected:
3575 ReferenceType(TypeClass tc, QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef,
3576 bool SpelledAsLValue)
3577 : Type(tc, CanonicalRef, Referencee->getDependence()),
3578 PointeeType(Referencee) {
3579 ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue = SpelledAsLValue;
3580 ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef = Referencee->isReferenceType();
3581 }
3582
3583public:
3584 bool isSpelledAsLValue() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue; }
3585 bool isInnerRef() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef; }
3586
3587 QualType getPointeeTypeAsWritten() const { return PointeeType; }
3588
3590 // FIXME: this might strip inner qualifiers; okay?
3591 const ReferenceType *T = this;
3592 while (T->isInnerRef())
3593 T = T->PointeeType->castAs<ReferenceType>();
3594 return T->PointeeType;
3595 }
3596
3597 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3598 Profile(ID, PointeeType, isSpelledAsLValue());
3599 }
3600
3601 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
3602 QualType Referencee,
3603 bool SpelledAsLValue) {
3604 ID.AddPointer(Referencee.getAsOpaquePtr());
3605 ID.AddBoolean(SpelledAsLValue);
3606 }
3607
3608 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3609 return T->getTypeClass() == LValueReference ||
3610 T->getTypeClass() == RValueReference;
3611 }
3612};
3613
3614/// An lvalue reference type, per C++11 [dcl.ref].
3615class LValueReferenceType : public ReferenceType {
3616 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
3617
3618 LValueReferenceType(QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef,
3619 bool SpelledAsLValue)
3620 : ReferenceType(LValueReference, Referencee, CanonicalRef,
3621 SpelledAsLValue) {}
3622
3623public:
3624 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3625 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3626
3627 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3628 return T->getTypeClass() == LValueReference;
3629 }
3630};
3631
3632/// An rvalue reference type, per C++11 [dcl.ref].
3633class RValueReferenceType : public ReferenceType {
3634 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
3635
3636 RValueReferenceType(QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef)
3637 : ReferenceType(RValueReference, Referencee, CanonicalRef, false) {}
3638
3639public:
3640 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3641 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3642
3643 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3644 return T->getTypeClass() == RValueReference;
3645 }
3646};
3647
3648/// A pointer to member type per C++ 8.3.3 - Pointers to members.
3649///
3650/// This includes both pointers to data members and pointer to member functions.
3651class MemberPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3652 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3653
3654 QualType PointeeType;
3655
3656 /// The class of which the pointee is a member. Must ultimately be a
3657 /// CXXRecordType, but could be a typedef or a template parameter too.
3658 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier;
3659
3660 MemberPointerType(QualType Pointee, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
3661 QualType CanonicalPtr)
3662 : Type(MemberPointer, CanonicalPtr,
3663 (toTypeDependence(Qualifier.getDependence()) &
3664 ~TypeDependence::VariablyModified) |
3665 Pointee->getDependence()),
3666 PointeeType(Pointee), Qualifier(Qualifier) {}
3667
3668public:
3669 QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
3670
3671 /// Returns true if the member type (i.e. the pointee type) is a
3672 /// function type rather than a data-member type.
3674 return PointeeType->isFunctionProtoType();
3675 }
3676
3677 /// Returns true if the member type (i.e. the pointee type) is a
3678 /// data type rather than a function type.
3679 bool isMemberDataPointer() const {
3680 return !PointeeType->isFunctionProtoType();
3681 }
3682
3683 NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const { return Qualifier; }
3684 /// Note: this can trigger extra deserialization when external AST sources are
3685 /// used. Prefer `getCXXRecordDecl()` unless you really need the most recent
3686 /// decl.
3687 CXXRecordDecl *getMostRecentCXXRecordDecl() const;
3688
3689 bool isSugared() const;
3691 return isSugared() ? getCanonicalTypeInternal() : QualType(this, 0);
3692 }
3693
3694 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3695 // FIXME: `getMostRecentCXXRecordDecl()` should be possible to use here,
3696 // however when external AST sources are used it causes nondeterminism
3697 // issues (see https://github.com/llvm/llvm-project/pull/137910).
3698 Profile(ID, getPointeeType(), getQualifier(), getCXXRecordDecl());
3699 }
3700
3701 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee,
3702 const NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
3703 const CXXRecordDecl *Cls);
3704
3705 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3706 return T->getTypeClass() == MemberPointer;
3707 }
3708
3709private:
3710 CXXRecordDecl *getCXXRecordDecl() const;
3711};
3712
3713/// Capture whether this is a normal array (e.g. int X[4])
3714/// an array with a static size (e.g. int X[static 4]), or an array
3715/// with a star size (e.g. int X[*]).
3716/// 'static' is only allowed on function parameters.
3718
3719/// Represents an array type, per C99 6.7.5.2 - Array Declarators.
3720class ArrayType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
3721private:
3722 /// The element type of the array.
3723 QualType ElementType;
3724
3725protected:
3726 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3727
3729 unsigned tq, const Expr *sz = nullptr);
3730
3731public:
3732 QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
3733
3735 return ArraySizeModifier(ArrayTypeBits.SizeModifier);
3736 }
3737
3741
3742 unsigned getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers() const {
3743 return ArrayTypeBits.IndexTypeQuals;
3744 }
3745
3746 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3747 return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantArray ||
3748 T->getTypeClass() == VariableArray ||
3749 T->getTypeClass() == IncompleteArray ||
3750 T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedArray ||
3751 T->getTypeClass() == ArrayParameter;
3752 }
3753};
3754
3755/// Represents the canonical version of C arrays with a specified constant size.
3756/// For example, the canonical type for 'int A[4 + 4*100]' is a
3757/// ConstantArrayType where the element type is 'int' and the size is 404.
3758class ConstantArrayType : public ArrayType {
3759 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3760
3761 struct ExternalSize {
3762 ExternalSize(const llvm::APInt &Sz, const Expr *SE)
3763 : Size(Sz), SizeExpr(SE) {}
3764 llvm::APInt Size; // Allows us to unique the type.
3765 const Expr *SizeExpr;
3766 };
3767
3768 union {
3769 uint64_t Size;
3770 ExternalSize *SizePtr;
3771 };
3772
3773 ConstantArrayType(QualType Et, QualType Can, uint64_t Width, uint64_t Sz,
3774 ArraySizeModifier SM, unsigned TQ)
3775 : ArrayType(ConstantArray, Et, Can, SM, TQ, nullptr), Size(Sz) {
3776 ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize = false;
3777 ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth = Width / 8;
3778 // The in-structure size stores the size in bytes rather than bits so we
3779 // drop the three least significant bits since they're always zero anyways.
3780 assert(Width < 0xFF && "Type width in bits must be less than 8 bits");
3781 }
3782
3783 ConstantArrayType(QualType Et, QualType Can, ExternalSize *SzPtr,
3784 ArraySizeModifier SM, unsigned TQ)
3785 : ArrayType(ConstantArray, Et, Can, SM, TQ, SzPtr->SizeExpr),
3786 SizePtr(SzPtr) {
3787 ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize = true;
3788 ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth = 0;
3789
3790 assert((SzPtr->SizeExpr == nullptr || !Can.isNull()) &&
3791 "canonical constant array should not have size expression");
3792 }
3793
3794 static ConstantArrayType *Create(const ASTContext &Ctx, QualType ET,
3795 QualType Can, const llvm::APInt &Sz,
3796 const Expr *SzExpr, ArraySizeModifier SzMod,
3797 unsigned Qual);
3798
3799protected:
3800 ConstantArrayType(TypeClass Tc, const ConstantArrayType *ATy, QualType Can)
3801 : ArrayType(Tc, ATy->getElementType(), Can, ATy->getSizeModifier(),
3802 ATy->getIndexTypeQualifiers().getAsOpaqueValue(), nullptr) {
3803 ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize =
3804 ATy->ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize;
3805 if (!ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize) {
3806 ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth = ATy->ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth;
3807 Size = ATy->Size;
3808 } else
3809 SizePtr = ATy->SizePtr;
3810 }
3811
3812public:
3813 /// Return the constant array size as an APInt.
3814 llvm::APInt getSize() const {
3815 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize
3816 ? SizePtr->Size
3817 : llvm::APInt(ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth * 8, Size);
3818 }
3819
3820 /// Return the bit width of the size type.
3821 unsigned getSizeBitWidth() const {
3822 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize
3823 ? SizePtr->Size.getBitWidth()
3824 : static_cast<unsigned>(ConstantArrayTypeBits.SizeWidth * 8);
3825 }
3826
3827 /// Return true if the size is zero.
3828 bool isZeroSize() const {
3829 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize ? SizePtr->Size.isZero()
3830 : 0 == Size;
3831 }
3832
3833 /// Return the size zero-extended as a uint64_t.
3834 uint64_t getZExtSize() const {
3835 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize ? SizePtr->Size.getZExtValue()
3836 : Size;
3837 }
3838
3839 /// Return the size sign-extended as a uint64_t.
3840 int64_t getSExtSize() const {
3841 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize ? SizePtr->Size.getSExtValue()
3842 : static_cast<int64_t>(Size);
3843 }
3844
3845 /// Return the size zero-extended to uint64_t or UINT64_MAX if the value is
3846 /// larger than UINT64_MAX.
3847 uint64_t getLimitedSize() const {
3848 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize
3849 ? SizePtr->Size.getLimitedValue()
3850 : Size;
3851 }
3852
3853 /// Return a pointer to the size expression.
3854 const Expr *getSizeExpr() const {
3855 return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasExternalSize ? SizePtr->SizeExpr : nullptr;
3856 }
3857
3858 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3859 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3860
3861 /// Determine the number of bits required to address a member of
3862 // an array with the given element type and number of elements.
3863 static unsigned getNumAddressingBits(const ASTContext &Context,
3864 QualType ElementType,
3865 const llvm::APInt &NumElements);
3866
3867 unsigned getNumAddressingBits(const ASTContext &Context) const;
3868
3869 /// Determine the maximum number of active bits that an array's size
3870 /// can require, which limits the maximum size of the array.
3871 static unsigned getMaxSizeBits(const ASTContext &Context);
3872
3873 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx) {
3876 }
3877
3878 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx,
3879 QualType ET, uint64_t ArraySize, const Expr *SizeExpr,
3880 ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, unsigned TypeQuals);
3881
3882 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3883 return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantArray ||
3884 T->getTypeClass() == ArrayParameter;
3885 }
3886};
3887
3888/// Represents a constant array type that does not decay to a pointer when used
3889/// as a function parameter.
3890class ArrayParameterType : public ConstantArrayType {
3891 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3892
3893 ArrayParameterType(const ConstantArrayType *ATy, QualType CanTy)
3894 : ConstantArrayType(ArrayParameter, ATy, CanTy) {}
3895
3896public:
3897 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3898 return T->getTypeClass() == ArrayParameter;
3899 }
3900
3901 QualType getConstantArrayType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
3902};
3903
3904/// Represents a C array with an unspecified size. For example 'int A[]' has
3905/// an IncompleteArrayType where the element type is 'int' and the size is
3906/// unspecified.
3907class IncompleteArrayType : public ArrayType {
3908 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3909
3910 IncompleteArrayType(QualType et, QualType can,
3911 ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq)
3912 : ArrayType(IncompleteArray, et, can, sm, tq) {}
3913
3914public:
3915 friend class StmtIteratorBase;
3916
3917 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3918 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3919
3920 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3921 return T->getTypeClass() == IncompleteArray;
3922 }
3923
3924 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3927 }
3928
3929 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ET,
3930 ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, unsigned TypeQuals) {
3931 ID.AddPointer(ET.getAsOpaquePtr());
3932 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(SizeMod));
3933 ID.AddInteger(TypeQuals);
3934 }
3935};
3936
3937/// Represents a C array with a specified size that is not an
3938/// integer-constant-expression. For example, 'int s[x+foo()]'.
3939/// Since the size expression is an arbitrary expression, we store it as such.
3940///
3941/// Note: VariableArrayType's aren't uniqued (since the expressions aren't) and
3942/// should not be: two lexically equivalent variable array types could mean
3943/// different things, for example, these variables do not have the same type
3944/// dynamically:
3945///
3946/// void foo(int x) {
3947/// int Y[x];
3948/// ++x;
3949/// int Z[x];
3950/// }
3951///
3952/// FIXME: Even constant array types might be represented by a
3953/// VariableArrayType, as in:
3954///
3955/// void func(int n) {
3956/// int array[7][n];
3957/// }
3958///
3959/// Even though 'array' is a constant-size array of seven elements of type
3960/// variable-length array of size 'n', it will be represented as a
3961/// VariableArrayType whose 'SizeExpr' is an IntegerLiteral whose value is 7.
3962/// Instead, this should be a ConstantArrayType whose element is a
3963/// VariableArrayType, which models the type better.
3964class VariableArrayType : public ArrayType {
3965 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
3966
3967 /// An assignment-expression. VLA's are only permitted within
3968 /// a function block.
3969 Stmt *SizeExpr;
3970
3971 VariableArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, Expr *e, ArraySizeModifier sm,
3972 unsigned tq)
3973 : ArrayType(VariableArray, et, can, sm, tq, e), SizeExpr((Stmt *)e) {}
3974
3975public:
3976 friend class StmtIteratorBase;
3977
3979 // We use C-style casts instead of cast<> here because we do not wish
3980 // to have a dependency of Type.h on Stmt.h/Expr.h.
3981 return (Expr*) SizeExpr;
3982 }
3983
3984 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
3985 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
3986
3987 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
3988 return T->getTypeClass() == VariableArray;
3989 }
3990
3991 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
3992 llvm_unreachable("Cannot unique VariableArrayTypes.");
3993 }
3994};
3995
3996/// Represents an array type in C++ whose size is a value-dependent expression.
3997///
3998/// For example:
3999/// \code
4000/// template<typename T, int Size>
4001/// class array {
4002/// T data[Size];
4003/// };
4004/// \endcode
4005///
4006/// For these types, we won't actually know what the array bound is
4007/// until template instantiation occurs, at which point this will
4008/// become either a ConstantArrayType or a VariableArrayType.
4009class DependentSizedArrayType : public ArrayType {
4010 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
4011
4012 /// An assignment expression that will instantiate to the
4013 /// size of the array.
4014 ///
4015 /// The expression itself might be null, in which case the array
4016 /// type will have its size deduced from an initializer.
4017 Stmt *SizeExpr;
4018
4019 DependentSizedArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, Expr *e,
4020 ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq);
4021
4022public:
4023 friend class StmtIteratorBase;
4024
4026 // We use C-style casts instead of cast<> here because we do not wish
4027 // to have a dependency of Type.h on Stmt.h/Expr.h.
4028 return (Expr*) SizeExpr;
4029 }
4030
4031 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4032 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4033
4034 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4035 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedArray;
4036 }
4037
4038 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
4039 Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(),
4041 }
4042
4043 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
4044 QualType ET, ArraySizeModifier SizeMod,
4045 unsigned TypeQuals, Expr *E);
4046};
4047
4048/// Represents an extended address space qualifier where the input address space
4049/// value is dependent. Non-dependent address spaces are not represented with a
4050/// special Type subclass; they are stored on an ExtQuals node as part of a QualType.
4051///
4052/// For example:
4053/// \code
4054/// template<typename T, int AddrSpace>
4055/// class AddressSpace {
4056/// typedef T __attribute__((address_space(AddrSpace))) type;
4057/// }
4058/// \endcode
4059class DependentAddressSpaceType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4060 friend class ASTContext;
4061
4062 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr;
4063 QualType PointeeType;
4064 SourceLocation loc;
4065
4066 DependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType, QualType can,
4067 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr, SourceLocation loc);
4068
4069public:
4070 Expr *getAddrSpaceExpr() const { return AddrSpaceExpr; }
4071 QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
4072 SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; }
4073
4074 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4075 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4076
4077 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4078 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentAddressSpace;
4079 }
4080
4081 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
4082 Profile(ID, Context, getPointeeType(), getAddrSpaceExpr());
4083 }
4084
4085 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
4086 QualType PointeeType, Expr *AddrSpaceExpr);
4087};
4088
4089/// Represents an extended vector type where either the type or size is
4090/// dependent.
4091///
4092/// For example:
4093/// \code
4094/// template<typename T, int Size>
4095/// class vector {
4096/// typedef T __attribute__((ext_vector_type(Size))) type;
4097/// }
4098/// \endcode
4099class DependentSizedExtVectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4100 friend class ASTContext;
4101
4102 Expr *SizeExpr;
4103
4104 /// The element type of the array.
4105 QualType ElementType;
4106
4107 SourceLocation loc;
4108
4109 DependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType ElementType, QualType can,
4110 Expr *SizeExpr, SourceLocation loc);
4111
4112public:
4113 Expr *getSizeExpr() const { return SizeExpr; }
4114 QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
4115 SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; }
4116
4117 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4118 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4119
4120 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4121 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedExtVector;
4122 }
4123
4124 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
4125 Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getSizeExpr());
4126 }
4127
4128 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
4129 QualType ElementType, Expr *SizeExpr);
4130};
4131
4132enum class VectorKind {
4133 /// not a target-specific vector type
4135
4136 /// is AltiVec vector
4138
4139 /// is AltiVec 'vector Pixel'
4141
4142 /// is AltiVec 'vector bool ...'
4144
4145 /// is ARM Neon vector
4147
4148 /// is ARM Neon polynomial vector
4150
4151 /// is AArch64 SVE fixed-length data vector
4153
4154 /// is AArch64 SVE fixed-length predicate vector
4156
4157 /// is RISC-V RVV fixed-length data vector
4159
4160 /// is RISC-V RVV fixed-length mask vector
4162
4166};
4167
4168/// Represents a GCC generic vector type. This type is created using
4169/// __attribute__((vector_size(n)), where "n" specifies the vector size in
4170/// bytes; or from an Altivec __vector or vector declaration.
4171/// Since the constructor takes the number of vector elements, the
4172/// client is responsible for converting the size into the number of elements.
4173class VectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4174protected:
4175 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
4176
4177 /// The element type of the vector.
4179
4180 VectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType,
4181 VectorKind vecKind);
4182
4183 VectorType(TypeClass tc, QualType vecType, unsigned nElements,
4184 QualType canonType, VectorKind vecKind);
4185
4186public:
4188 unsigned getNumElements() const { return VectorTypeBits.NumElements; }
4189
4190 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4191 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4192
4194 return VectorKind(VectorTypeBits.VecKind);
4195 }
4196
4197 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
4200 }
4201
4202 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType,
4203 unsigned NumElements, TypeClass TypeClass,
4204 VectorKind VecKind) {
4205 ID.AddPointer(ElementType.getAsOpaquePtr());
4206 ID.AddInteger(NumElements);
4207 ID.AddInteger(TypeClass);
4208 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(VecKind));
4209 }
4210
4211 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4212 return T->getTypeClass() == Vector || T->getTypeClass() == ExtVector;
4213 }
4214};
4215
4216/// Represents a vector type where either the type or size is dependent.
4217////
4218/// For example:
4219/// \code
4220/// template<typename T, int Size>
4221/// class vector {
4222/// typedef T __attribute__((vector_size(Size))) type;
4223/// }
4224/// \endcode
4225class DependentVectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4226 friend class ASTContext;
4227
4228 QualType ElementType;
4229 Expr *SizeExpr;
4230 SourceLocation Loc;
4231
4232 DependentVectorType(QualType ElementType, QualType CanonType, Expr *SizeExpr,
4233 SourceLocation Loc, VectorKind vecKind);
4234
4235public:
4236 Expr *getSizeExpr() const { return SizeExpr; }
4237 QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
4238 SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return Loc; }
4240 return VectorKind(VectorTypeBits.VecKind);
4241 }
4242
4243 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4244 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4245
4246 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4247 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentVector;
4248 }
4249
4250 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
4251 Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getSizeExpr(), getVectorKind());
4252 }
4253
4254 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
4255 QualType ElementType, const Expr *SizeExpr,
4256 VectorKind VecKind);
4257};
4258
4259/// ExtVectorType - Extended vector type. This type is created using
4260/// __attribute__((ext_vector_type(n)), where "n" is the number of elements.
4261/// Unlike vector_size, ext_vector_type is only allowed on typedef's. This
4262/// class enables syntactic extensions, like Vector Components for accessing
4263/// points (as .xyzw), colors (as .rgba), and textures (modeled after OpenGL
4264/// Shading Language).
4265class ExtVectorType : public VectorType {
4266 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
4267
4268 ExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType)
4269 : VectorType(ExtVector, vecType, nElements, canonType,
4270 VectorKind::Generic) {}
4271
4272public:
4273 static int getPointAccessorIdx(char c) {
4274 switch (c) {
4275 default: return -1;
4276 case 'x': case 'r': return 0;
4277 case 'y': case 'g': return 1;
4278 case 'z': case 'b': return 2;
4279 case 'w': case 'a': return 3;
4280 }
4281 }
4282
4283 static int getNumericAccessorIdx(char c) {
4284 switch (c) {
4285 default: return -1;
4286 case '0': return 0;
4287 case '1': return 1;
4288 case '2': return 2;
4289 case '3': return 3;
4290 case '4': return 4;
4291 case '5': return 5;
4292 case '6': return 6;
4293 case '7': return 7;
4294 case '8': return 8;
4295 case '9': return 9;
4296 case 'A':
4297 case 'a': return 10;
4298 case 'B':
4299 case 'b': return 11;
4300 case 'C':
4301 case 'c': return 12;
4302 case 'D':
4303 case 'd': return 13;
4304 case 'E':
4305 case 'e': return 14;
4306 case 'F':
4307 case 'f': return 15;
4308 }
4309 }
4310
4311 static int getAccessorIdx(char c, bool isNumericAccessor) {
4312 if (isNumericAccessor)
4313 return getNumericAccessorIdx(c);
4314 else
4315 return getPointAccessorIdx(c);
4316 }
4317
4318 bool isAccessorWithinNumElements(char c, bool isNumericAccessor) const {
4319 if (int idx = getAccessorIdx(c, isNumericAccessor)+1)
4320 return unsigned(idx-1) < getNumElements();
4321 return false;
4322 }
4323
4324 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4325 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4326
4327 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4328 return T->getTypeClass() == ExtVector;
4329 }
4330};
4331
4332/// Represents a matrix type, as defined in the Matrix Types clang extensions.
4333/// __attribute__((matrix_type(rows, columns))), where "rows" specifies
4334/// number of rows and "columns" specifies the number of columns.
4335class MatrixType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4336protected:
4337 friend class ASTContext;
4338
4339 /// The element type of the matrix.
4341
4342 MatrixType(QualType ElementTy, QualType CanonElementTy);
4343
4344 MatrixType(TypeClass TypeClass, QualType ElementTy, QualType CanonElementTy,
4345 const Expr *RowExpr = nullptr, const Expr *ColumnExpr = nullptr);
4346
4347public:
4348 /// Returns type of the elements being stored in the matrix
4350
4351 /// Valid elements types are the following:
4352 /// * an integer type (as in C23 6.2.5p22), but excluding enumerated types
4353 /// and _Bool
4354 /// * the standard floating types float or double
4355 /// * a half-precision floating point type, if one is supported on the target
4357 return T->isDependentType() ||
4358 (T->isRealType() && !T->isBooleanType() && !T->isEnumeralType());
4359 }
4360
4361 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4362 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4363
4364 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4365 return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantMatrix ||
4366 T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedMatrix;
4367 }
4368};
4369
4370/// Represents a concrete matrix type with constant number of rows and columns
4371class ConstantMatrixType final : public MatrixType {
4372protected:
4373 friend class ASTContext;
4374
4375 /// Number of rows and columns.
4376 unsigned NumRows;
4377 unsigned NumColumns;
4378
4379 static constexpr unsigned MaxElementsPerDimension = (1 << 20) - 1;
4380
4381 ConstantMatrixType(QualType MatrixElementType, unsigned NRows,
4382 unsigned NColumns, QualType CanonElementType);
4383
4384 ConstantMatrixType(TypeClass typeClass, QualType MatrixType, unsigned NRows,
4385 unsigned NColumns, QualType CanonElementType);
4386
4387public:
4388 /// Returns the number of rows in the matrix.
4389 unsigned getNumRows() const { return NumRows; }
4390
4391 /// Returns the number of columns in the matrix.
4392 unsigned getNumColumns() const { return NumColumns; }
4393
4394 /// Returns the number of elements required to embed the matrix into a vector.
4395 unsigned getNumElementsFlattened() const {
4396 return getNumRows() * getNumColumns();
4397 }
4398
4399 /// Returns true if \p NumElements is a valid matrix dimension.
4400 static constexpr bool isDimensionValid(size_t NumElements) {
4401 return NumElements > 0 && NumElements <= MaxElementsPerDimension;
4402 }
4403
4404 /// Returns the maximum number of elements per dimension.
4405 static constexpr unsigned getMaxElementsPerDimension() {
4407 }
4408
4409 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
4411 getTypeClass());
4412 }
4413
4414 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType,
4415 unsigned NumRows, unsigned NumColumns,
4417 ID.AddPointer(ElementType.getAsOpaquePtr());
4418 ID.AddInteger(NumRows);
4419 ID.AddInteger(NumColumns);
4420 ID.AddInteger(TypeClass);
4421 }
4422
4423 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4424 return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantMatrix;
4425 }
4426};
4427
4428/// Represents a matrix type where the type and the number of rows and columns
4429/// is dependent on a template.
4430class DependentSizedMatrixType final : public MatrixType {
4431 friend class ASTContext;
4432
4433 Expr *RowExpr;
4434 Expr *ColumnExpr;
4435
4436 SourceLocation loc;
4437
4438 DependentSizedMatrixType(QualType ElementType, QualType CanonicalType,
4439 Expr *RowExpr, Expr *ColumnExpr, SourceLocation loc);
4440
4441public:
4442 Expr *getRowExpr() const { return RowExpr; }
4443 Expr *getColumnExpr() const { return ColumnExpr; }
4444 SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; }
4445
4446 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4447 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedMatrix;
4448 }
4449
4450 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
4451 Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getRowExpr(), getColumnExpr());
4452 }
4453
4454 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
4455 QualType ElementType, Expr *RowExpr, Expr *ColumnExpr);
4456};
4457
4458/// FunctionType - C99 6.7.5.3 - Function Declarators. This is the common base
4459/// class of FunctionNoProtoType and FunctionProtoType.
4460class FunctionType : public Type {
4461 // The type returned by the function.
4462 QualType ResultType;
4463
4464public:
4465 /// Interesting information about a specific parameter that can't simply
4466 /// be reflected in parameter's type. This is only used by FunctionProtoType
4467 /// but is in FunctionType to make this class available during the
4468 /// specification of the bases of FunctionProtoType.
4469 ///
4470 /// It makes sense to model language features this way when there's some
4471 /// sort of parameter-specific override (such as an attribute) that
4472 /// affects how the function is called. For example, the ARC ns_consumed
4473 /// attribute changes whether a parameter is passed at +0 (the default)
4474 /// or +1 (ns_consumed). This must be reflected in the function type,
4475 /// but isn't really a change to the parameter type.
4476 ///
4477 /// One serious disadvantage of modelling language features this way is
4478 /// that they generally do not work with language features that attempt
4479 /// to destructure types. For example, template argument deduction will
4480 /// not be able to match a parameter declared as
4481 /// T (*)(U)
4482 /// against an argument of type
4483 /// void (*)(__attribute__((ns_consumed)) id)
4484 /// because the substitution of T=void, U=id into the former will
4485 /// not produce the latter.
4487 enum {
4488 ABIMask = 0x0F,
4489 IsConsumed = 0x10,
4490 HasPassObjSize = 0x20,
4491 IsNoEscape = 0x40,
4492 };
4493 unsigned char Data = 0;
4494
4495 public:
4496 ExtParameterInfo() = default;
4497
4498 /// Return the ABI treatment of this parameter.
4499 ParameterABI getABI() const { return ParameterABI(Data & ABIMask); }
4501 ExtParameterInfo copy = *this;
4502 copy.Data = (copy.Data & ~ABIMask) | unsigned(kind);
4503 return copy;
4504 }
4505
4506 /// Is this parameter considered "consumed" by Objective-C ARC?
4507 /// Consumed parameters must have retainable object type.
4508 bool isConsumed() const { return (Data & IsConsumed); }
4510 ExtParameterInfo copy = *this;
4511 if (consumed)
4512 copy.Data |= IsConsumed;
4513 else
4514 copy.Data &= ~IsConsumed;
4515 return copy;
4516 }
4517
4518 bool hasPassObjectSize() const { return Data & HasPassObjSize; }
4520 ExtParameterInfo Copy = *this;
4521 Copy.Data |= HasPassObjSize;
4522 return Copy;
4523 }
4524
4525 bool isNoEscape() const { return Data & IsNoEscape; }
4526 ExtParameterInfo withIsNoEscape(bool NoEscape) const {
4527 ExtParameterInfo Copy = *this;
4528 if (NoEscape)
4529 Copy.Data |= IsNoEscape;
4530 else
4531 Copy.Data &= ~IsNoEscape;
4532 return Copy;
4533 }
4534
4535 unsigned char getOpaqueValue() const { return Data; }
4536 static ExtParameterInfo getFromOpaqueValue(unsigned char data) {
4537 ExtParameterInfo result;
4538 result.Data = data;
4539 return result;
4540 }
4541
4543 return lhs.Data == rhs.Data;
4544 }
4545
4547 return lhs.Data != rhs.Data;
4548 }
4549 };
4550
4551 /// A class which abstracts out some details necessary for
4552 /// making a call.
4553 ///
4554 /// It is not actually used directly for storing this information in
4555 /// a FunctionType, although FunctionType does currently use the
4556 /// same bit-pattern.
4557 ///
4558 // If you add a field (say Foo), other than the obvious places (both,
4559 // constructors, compile failures), what you need to update is
4560 // * Operator==
4561 // * getFoo
4562 // * withFoo
4563 // * functionType. Add Foo, getFoo.
4564 // * ASTContext::getFooType
4565 // * ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes
4566 // * FunctionNoProtoType::Profile
4567 // * FunctionProtoType::Profile
4568 // * TypePrinter::PrintFunctionProto
4569 // * AST read and write
4570 // * Codegen
4571 class ExtInfo {
4572 friend class FunctionType;
4573
4574 // Feel free to rearrange or add bits, but if you go over 16, you'll need to
4575 // adjust the Bits field below, and if you add bits, you'll need to adjust
4576 // Type::FunctionTypeBitfields::ExtInfo as well.
4577
4578 // | CC |noreturn|produces|nocallersavedregs|regparm|nocfcheck|cmsenscall|
4579 // |0 .. 5| 6 | 7 | 8 |9 .. 11| 12 | 13 |
4580 //
4581 // regparm is either 0 (no regparm attribute) or the regparm value+1.
4582 enum { CallConvMask = 0x3F };
4583 enum { NoReturnMask = 0x40 };
4584 enum { ProducesResultMask = 0x80 };
4585 enum { NoCallerSavedRegsMask = 0x100 };
4586 enum { RegParmMask = 0xe00, RegParmOffset = 9 };
4587 enum { NoCfCheckMask = 0x1000 };
4588 enum { CmseNSCallMask = 0x2000 };
4589 uint16_t Bits = CC_C;
4590
4591 ExtInfo(unsigned Bits) : Bits(static_cast<uint16_t>(Bits)) {}
4592
4593 public:
4594 // Constructor with no defaults. Use this when you know that you
4595 // have all the elements (when reading an AST file for example).
4596 ExtInfo(bool noReturn, bool hasRegParm, unsigned regParm, CallingConv cc,
4597 bool producesResult, bool noCallerSavedRegs, bool NoCfCheck,
4598 bool cmseNSCall) {
4599 assert((!hasRegParm || regParm < 7) && "Invalid regparm value");
4600 Bits = ((unsigned)cc) | (noReturn ? NoReturnMask : 0) |
4601 (producesResult ? ProducesResultMask : 0) |
4602 (noCallerSavedRegs ? NoCallerSavedRegsMask : 0) |
4603 (hasRegParm ? ((regParm + 1) << RegParmOffset) : 0) |
4604 (NoCfCheck ? NoCfCheckMask : 0) |
4605 (cmseNSCall ? CmseNSCallMask : 0);
4606 }
4607
4608 // Constructor with all defaults. Use when for example creating a
4609 // function known to use defaults.
4610 ExtInfo() = default;
4611
4612 // Constructor with just the calling convention, which is an important part
4613 // of the canonical type.
4614 ExtInfo(CallingConv CC) : Bits(CC) {}
4615
4616 bool getNoReturn() const { return Bits & NoReturnMask; }
4617 bool getProducesResult() const { return Bits & ProducesResultMask; }
4618 bool getCmseNSCall() const { return Bits & CmseNSCallMask; }
4619 bool getNoCallerSavedRegs() const { return Bits & NoCallerSavedRegsMask; }
4620 bool getNoCfCheck() const { return Bits & NoCfCheckMask; }
4621 bool getHasRegParm() const { return ((Bits & RegParmMask) >> RegParmOffset) != 0; }
4622
4623 unsigned getRegParm() const {
4624 unsigned RegParm = (Bits & RegParmMask) >> RegParmOffset;
4625 if (RegParm > 0)
4626 --RegParm;
4627 return RegParm;
4628 }
4629
4630 CallingConv getCC() const { return CallingConv(Bits & CallConvMask); }
4631
4632 bool operator==(ExtInfo Other) const {
4633 return Bits == Other.Bits;
4634 }
4635 bool operator!=(ExtInfo Other) const {
4636 return Bits != Other.Bits;
4637 }
4638
4639 // Note that we don't have setters. That is by design, use
4640 // the following with methods instead of mutating these objects.
4641
4642 ExtInfo withNoReturn(bool noReturn) const {
4643 if (noReturn)
4644 return ExtInfo(Bits | NoReturnMask);
4645 else
4646 return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoReturnMask);
4647 }
4648
4649 ExtInfo withProducesResult(bool producesResult) const {
4650 if (producesResult)
4651 return ExtInfo(Bits | ProducesResultMask);
4652 else
4653 return ExtInfo(Bits & ~ProducesResultMask);
4654 }
4655
4656 ExtInfo withCmseNSCall(bool cmseNSCall) const {
4657 if (cmseNSCall)
4658 return ExtInfo(Bits | CmseNSCallMask);
4659 else
4660 return ExtInfo(Bits & ~CmseNSCallMask);
4661 }
4662
4663 ExtInfo withNoCallerSavedRegs(bool noCallerSavedRegs) const {
4664 if (noCallerSavedRegs)
4665 return ExtInfo(Bits | NoCallerSavedRegsMask);
4666 else
4667 return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoCallerSavedRegsMask);
4668 }
4669
4670 ExtInfo withNoCfCheck(bool noCfCheck) const {
4671 if (noCfCheck)
4672 return ExtInfo(Bits | NoCfCheckMask);
4673 else
4674 return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoCfCheckMask);
4675 }
4676
4677 ExtInfo withRegParm(unsigned RegParm) const {
4678 assert(RegParm < 7 && "Invalid regparm value");
4679 return ExtInfo((Bits & ~RegParmMask) |
4680 ((RegParm + 1) << RegParmOffset));
4681 }
4682
4683 ExtInfo withCallingConv(CallingConv cc) const {
4684 return ExtInfo((Bits & ~CallConvMask) | (unsigned) cc);
4685 }
4686
4687 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
4688 ID.AddInteger(Bits);
4689 }
4690 };
4691
4692 /// A simple holder for a QualType representing a type in an
4693 /// exception specification. Unfortunately needed by FunctionProtoType
4694 /// because TrailingObjects cannot handle repeated types.
4696
4697 /// A simple holder for various uncommon bits which do not fit in
4698 /// FunctionTypeBitfields. Aligned to alignof(void *) to maintain the
4699 /// alignment of subsequent objects in TrailingObjects.
4700 struct alignas(void *) FunctionTypeExtraBitfields {
4701 /// The number of types in the exception specification.
4702 /// A whole unsigned is not needed here and according to
4703 /// [implimits] 8 bits would be enough here.
4704 unsigned NumExceptionType : 10;
4705
4706 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
4708
4709 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
4711
4712 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
4715
4720 };
4721
4722 /// A holder for extra information from attributes which aren't part of an
4723 /// \p AttributedType.
4724 struct alignas(void *) FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo {
4725 /// A CFI "salt" that differentiates functions with the same prototype.
4726 StringRef CFISalt;
4727
4728 operator bool() const { return !CFISalt.empty(); }
4729
4730 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { ID.AddString(CFISalt); }
4731 };
4732
4733 /// The AArch64 SME ACLE (Arm C/C++ Language Extensions) define a number
4734 /// of function type attributes that can be set on function types, including
4735 /// function pointers.
4740
4741 // Describes the value of the state using ArmStateValue.
4746
4747 // A bit to tell whether a function is agnostic about sme ZA state.
4750
4752 0b1'111'111'11 // We can't support more than 9 bits because of
4753 // the bitmask in FunctionTypeArmAttributes
4754 // and ExtProtoInfo.
4755 };
4756
4757 enum ArmStateValue : unsigned {
4763 };
4764
4765 static ArmStateValue getArmZAState(unsigned AttrBits) {
4766 return static_cast<ArmStateValue>((AttrBits & SME_ZAMask) >> SME_ZAShift);
4767 }
4768
4769 static ArmStateValue getArmZT0State(unsigned AttrBits) {
4770 return static_cast<ArmStateValue>((AttrBits & SME_ZT0Mask) >> SME_ZT0Shift);
4771 }
4772
4773 /// A holder for Arm type attributes as described in the Arm C/C++
4774 /// Language extensions which are not particularly common to all
4775 /// types and therefore accounted separately from FunctionTypeBitfields.
4776 struct alignas(void *) FunctionTypeArmAttributes {
4777 /// Any AArch64 SME ACLE type attributes that need to be propagated
4778 /// on declarations and function pointers.
4779 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(AArch64SMETypeAttributes)
4781
4783 };
4784
4785protected:
4788 : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependence), ResultType(res) {
4789 FunctionTypeBits.ExtInfo = Info.Bits;
4790 }
4791
4793 if (isFunctionProtoType())
4794 return Qualifiers::fromFastMask(FunctionTypeBits.FastTypeQuals);
4795
4796 return Qualifiers();
4797 }
4798
4799public:
4800 QualType getReturnType() const { return ResultType; }
4801
4802 bool getHasRegParm() const { return getExtInfo().getHasRegParm(); }
4803 unsigned getRegParmType() const { return getExtInfo().getRegParm(); }
4804
4805 /// Determine whether this function type includes the GNU noreturn
4806 /// attribute. The C++11 [[noreturn]] attribute does not affect the function
4807 /// type.
4808 bool getNoReturnAttr() const { return getExtInfo().getNoReturn(); }
4809
4810 /// Determine whether this is a function prototype that includes the
4811 /// cfi_unchecked_callee attribute.
4812 bool getCFIUncheckedCalleeAttr() const;
4813
4814 bool getCmseNSCallAttr() const { return getExtInfo().getCmseNSCall(); }
4815 CallingConv getCallConv() const { return getExtInfo().getCC(); }
4816 ExtInfo getExtInfo() const { return ExtInfo(FunctionTypeBits.ExtInfo); }
4817
4818 static_assert((~Qualifiers::FastMask & Qualifiers::CVRMask) == 0,
4819 "Const, volatile and restrict are assumed to be a subset of "
4820 "the fast qualifiers.");
4821
4822 bool isConst() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasConst(); }
4823 bool isVolatile() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasVolatile(); }
4824 bool isRestrict() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasRestrict(); }
4825
4826 /// Determine the type of an expression that calls a function of
4827 /// this type.
4828 QualType getCallResultType(const ASTContext &Context) const {
4829 return getReturnType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4830 }
4831
4832 static StringRef getNameForCallConv(CallingConv CC);
4833
4834 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4835 return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionNoProto ||
4836 T->getTypeClass() == FunctionProto;
4837 }
4838};
4839
4840/// Represents a K&R-style 'int foo()' function, which has
4841/// no information available about its arguments.
4842class FunctionNoProtoType : public FunctionType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
4843 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
4844
4845 FunctionNoProtoType(QualType Result, QualType Canonical, ExtInfo Info)
4846 : FunctionType(FunctionNoProto, Result, Canonical,
4848 ~(TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation |
4849 TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack),
4850 Info) {}
4851
4852public:
4853 // No additional state past what FunctionType provides.
4854
4855 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
4856 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
4857
4858 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
4860 }
4861
4862 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ResultType,
4863 ExtInfo Info) {
4864 Info.Profile(ID);
4865 ID.AddPointer(ResultType.getAsOpaquePtr());
4866 }
4867
4868 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
4869 return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionNoProto;
4870 }
4871};
4872
4873// ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4874
4875/// Represents an abstract function effect, using just an enumeration describing
4876/// its kind.
4878public:
4879 /// Identifies the particular effect.
4887 constexpr static size_t KindCount = static_cast<size_t>(Kind::Last) + 1;
4888
4889 /// Flags describing some behaviors of the effect.
4892 // Can verification inspect callees' implementations? (e.g. nonblocking:
4893 // yes, tcb+types: no). This also implies the need for 2nd-pass
4894 // verification.
4896
4897 // Language constructs which effects can diagnose as disallowed.
4903 };
4904
4905private:
4906 Kind FKind;
4907
4908 // Expansion: for hypothetical TCB+types, there could be one Kind for TCB,
4909 // then ~16(?) bits "SubKind" to map to a specific named TCB. SubKind would
4910 // be considered for uniqueness.
4911
4912public:
4913 explicit FunctionEffect(Kind K) : FKind(K) {}
4914
4915 /// The kind of the effect.
4916 Kind kind() const { return FKind; }
4917
4918 /// Return the opposite kind, for effects which have opposites.
4919 Kind oppositeKind() const;
4920
4921 /// For serialization.
4922 uint32_t toOpaqueInt32() const { return uint32_t(FKind); }
4924 return FunctionEffect(Kind(Value));
4925 }
4926
4927 /// Flags describing some behaviors of the effect.
4928 Flags flags() const {
4929 switch (kind()) {
4930 case Kind::NonBlocking:
4935 // Same as NonBlocking, except without FE_ExcludeStaticLocalVars.
4938 case Kind::Blocking:
4939 case Kind::Allocating:
4940 return 0;
4941 }
4942 llvm_unreachable("unknown effect kind");
4943 }
4944
4945 /// The description printed in diagnostics, e.g. 'nonblocking'.
4946 StringRef name() const;
4947
4948 friend raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS,
4949 const FunctionEffect &Effect) {
4950 OS << Effect.name();
4951 return OS;
4952 }
4953
4954 /// Determine whether the effect is allowed to be inferred on the callee,
4955 /// which is either a FunctionDecl or BlockDecl. If the returned optional
4956 /// is empty, inference is permitted; otherwise it holds the effect which
4957 /// blocked inference.
4958 /// Example: This allows nonblocking(false) to prevent inference for the
4959 /// function.
4960 std::optional<FunctionEffect>
4961 effectProhibitingInference(const Decl &Callee,
4962 FunctionEffectKindSet CalleeFX) const;
4963
4964 // Return false for success. When true is returned for a direct call, then the
4965 // FE_InferrableOnCallees flag may trigger inference rather than an immediate
4966 // diagnostic. Caller should be assumed to have the effect (it may not have it
4967 // explicitly when inferring).
4968 bool shouldDiagnoseFunctionCall(bool Direct,
4969 FunctionEffectKindSet CalleeFX) const;
4970
4972 return LHS.FKind == RHS.FKind;
4973 }
4975 return !(LHS == RHS);
4976 }
4978 return LHS.FKind < RHS.FKind;
4979 }
4980};
4981
4982/// Wrap a function effect's condition expression in another struct so
4983/// that FunctionProtoType's TrailingObjects can treat it separately.
4985 Expr *Cond = nullptr; // if null, unconditional.
4986
4987public:
4989 EffectConditionExpr(Expr *E) : Cond(E) {}
4990
4991 Expr *getCondition() const { return Cond; }
4992
4993 bool operator==(const EffectConditionExpr &RHS) const {
4994 return Cond == RHS.Cond;
4995 }
4996};
4997
4998/// A FunctionEffect plus a potential boolean expression determining whether
4999/// the effect is declared (e.g. nonblocking(expr)). Generally the condition
5000/// expression when present, is dependent.
5004
5007
5008 /// Return a textual description of the effect, and its condition, if any.
5009 std::string description() const;
5010
5011 friend raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS,
5012 const FunctionEffectWithCondition &CFE);
5013};
5014
5015/// Support iteration in parallel through a pair of FunctionEffect and
5016/// EffectConditionExpr containers.
5017template <typename Container> class FunctionEffectIterator {
5018 friend Container;
5019
5020 const Container *Outer = nullptr;
5021 size_t Idx = 0;
5022
5023public:
5025 FunctionEffectIterator(const Container &O, size_t I) : Outer(&O), Idx(I) {}
5027 return Idx == Other.Idx;
5028 }
5030 return Idx != Other.Idx;
5031 }
5032
5034 ++Idx;
5035 return *this;
5036 }
5037
5039 assert(Outer != nullptr && "invalid FunctionEffectIterator");
5040 bool HasConds = !Outer->Conditions.empty();
5041 return FunctionEffectWithCondition{Outer->Effects[Idx],
5042 HasConds ? Outer->Conditions[Idx]
5044 }
5045};
5046
5047/// An immutable set of FunctionEffects and possibly conditions attached to
5048/// them. The effects and conditions reside in memory not managed by this object
5049/// (typically, trailing objects in FunctionProtoType, or borrowed references
5050/// from a FunctionEffectSet).
5051///
5052/// Invariants:
5053/// - there is never more than one instance of any given effect.
5054/// - the array of conditions is either empty or has the same size as the
5055/// array of effects.
5056/// - some conditions may be null expressions; each condition pertains to
5057/// the effect at the same array index.
5058///
5059/// Also, if there are any conditions, at least one of those expressions will be
5060/// dependent, but this is only asserted in the constructor of
5061/// FunctionProtoType.
5062///
5063/// See also FunctionEffectSet, in Sema, which provides a mutable set.
5064class FunctionEffectsRef {
5065 // Restrict classes which can call the private constructor -- these friends
5066 // all maintain the required invariants. FunctionEffectSet is generally the
5067 // only way in which the arrays are created; FunctionProtoType will not
5068 // reorder them.
5069 friend FunctionProtoType;
5070 friend FunctionEffectSet;
5071
5074
5075 // The arrays are expected to have been sorted by the caller, with the
5076 // effects in order. The conditions array must be empty or the same size
5077 // as the effects array, since the conditions are associated with the effects
5078 // at the same array indices.
5079 FunctionEffectsRef(ArrayRef<FunctionEffect> FX,
5081 : Effects(FX), Conditions(Conds) {}
5082
5083public:
5084 /// Extract the effects from a Type if it is a function, block, or member
5085 /// function pointer, or a reference or pointer to one.
5086 static FunctionEffectsRef get(QualType QT);
5087
5088 /// Asserts invariants.
5089 static FunctionEffectsRef create(ArrayRef<FunctionEffect> FX,
5091
5093
5094 bool empty() const { return Effects.empty(); }
5095 size_t size() const { return Effects.size(); }
5096
5097 ArrayRef<FunctionEffect> effects() const { return Effects; }
5098 ArrayRef<EffectConditionExpr> conditions() const { return Conditions; }
5099
5101 friend iterator;
5102 iterator begin() const { return iterator(*this, 0); }
5103 iterator end() const { return iterator(*this, size()); }
5104
5105 friend bool operator==(const FunctionEffectsRef &LHS,
5106 const FunctionEffectsRef &RHS) {
5107 return LHS.Effects == RHS.Effects && LHS.Conditions == RHS.Conditions;
5108 }
5109 friend bool operator!=(const FunctionEffectsRef &LHS,
5110 const FunctionEffectsRef &RHS) {
5111 return !(LHS == RHS);
5112 }
5113
5114 void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS) const;
5115};
5116
5117/// A mutable set of FunctionEffect::Kind.
5118class FunctionEffectKindSet {
5119 // For now this only needs to be a bitmap.
5120 constexpr static size_t EndBitPos = FunctionEffect::KindCount;
5121 using KindBitsT = std::bitset<EndBitPos>;
5122
5123 KindBitsT KindBits{};
5124
5125 explicit FunctionEffectKindSet(KindBitsT KB) : KindBits(KB) {}
5126
5127 // Functions to translate between an effect kind, starting at 1, and a
5128 // position in the bitset.
5129
5130 constexpr static size_t kindToPos(FunctionEffect::Kind K) {
5131 return static_cast<size_t>(K);
5132 }
5133
5134 constexpr static FunctionEffect::Kind posToKind(size_t Pos) {
5135 return static_cast<FunctionEffect::Kind>(Pos);
5136 }
5137
5138 // Iterates through the bits which are set.
5139 class iterator {
5140 const FunctionEffectKindSet *Outer = nullptr;
5141 size_t Idx = 0;
5142
5143 // If Idx does not reference a set bit, advance it until it does,
5144 // or until it reaches EndBitPos.
5145 void advanceToNextSetBit() {
5146 while (Idx < EndBitPos && !Outer->KindBits.test(Idx))
5147 ++Idx;
5148 }
5149
5150 public:
5151 iterator();
5152 iterator(const FunctionEffectKindSet &O, size_t I) : Outer(&O), Idx(I) {
5153 advanceToNextSetBit();
5154 }
5155 bool operator==(const iterator &Other) const { return Idx == Other.Idx; }
5156 bool operator!=(const iterator &Other) const { return Idx != Other.Idx; }
5157
5158 iterator operator++() {
5159 ++Idx;
5160 advanceToNextSetBit();
5161 return *this;
5162 }
5163
5164 FunctionEffect operator*() const {
5165 assert(Idx < EndBitPos && "Dereference of end iterator");
5166 return FunctionEffect(posToKind(Idx));
5167 }
5168 };
5169
5170public:
5173
5174 iterator begin() const { return iterator(*this, 0); }
5175 iterator end() const { return iterator(*this, EndBitPos); }
5176
5177 void insert(FunctionEffect Effect) { KindBits.set(kindToPos(Effect.kind())); }
5179 for (FunctionEffect Item : FX.effects())
5180 insert(Item);
5181 }
5182 void insert(FunctionEffectKindSet Set) { KindBits |= Set.KindBits; }
5183
5184 bool empty() const { return KindBits.none(); }
5185 bool contains(const FunctionEffect::Kind EK) const {
5186 return KindBits.test(kindToPos(EK));
5187 }
5188 void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS) const;
5189
5190 static FunctionEffectKindSet difference(FunctionEffectKindSet LHS,
5191 FunctionEffectKindSet RHS) {
5192 return FunctionEffectKindSet(LHS.KindBits & ~RHS.KindBits);
5193 }
5194};
5195
5196/// A mutable set of FunctionEffects and possibly conditions attached to them.
5197/// Used to compare and merge effects on declarations.
5198///
5199/// Has the same invariants as FunctionEffectsRef.
5203
5204public:
5206
5208 : Effects(FX.effects()), Conditions(FX.conditions()) {}
5209
5210 bool empty() const { return Effects.empty(); }
5211 size_t size() const { return Effects.size(); }
5212
5214 friend iterator;
5215 iterator begin() const { return iterator(*this, 0); }
5216 iterator end() const { return iterator(*this, size()); }
5217
5218 operator FunctionEffectsRef() const { return {Effects, Conditions}; }
5219
5220 void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS) const;
5221
5222 // Mutators
5223
5224 // On insertion, a conflict occurs when attempting to insert an
5225 // effect which is opposite an effect already in the set, or attempting
5226 // to insert an effect which is already in the set but with a condition
5227 // which is not identical.
5233
5234 // Returns true for success (obviating a check of Errs.empty()).
5235 bool insert(const FunctionEffectWithCondition &NewEC, Conflicts &Errs);
5236
5237 // Returns true for success (obviating a check of Errs.empty()).
5238 bool insert(const FunctionEffectsRef &Set, Conflicts &Errs);
5239
5240 // Set operations
5241
5243 FunctionEffectsRef RHS, Conflicts &Errs);
5245 FunctionEffectsRef RHS);
5246};
5247
5248/// Represents a prototype with parameter type info, e.g.
5249/// 'int foo(int)' or 'int foo(void)'. 'void' is represented as having no
5250/// parameters, not as having a single void parameter. Such a type can have
5251/// an exception specification, but this specification is not part of the
5252/// canonical type. FunctionProtoType has several trailing objects, some of
5253/// which optional. For more information about the trailing objects see
5254/// the first comment inside FunctionProtoType.
5255class FunctionProtoType final
5256 : public FunctionType,
5257 public llvm::FoldingSetNode,
5258 private llvm::TrailingObjects<
5259 FunctionProtoType, QualType, SourceLocation,
5260 FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraBitfields,
5261 FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo,
5262 FunctionType::FunctionTypeArmAttributes, FunctionType::ExceptionType,
5263 Expr *, FunctionDecl *, FunctionType::ExtParameterInfo, Qualifiers,
5264 FunctionEffect, EffectConditionExpr> {
5265 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
5266 friend TrailingObjects;
5267
5268 // FunctionProtoType is followed by several trailing objects, some of
5269 // which optional. They are in order:
5270 //
5271 // * An array of getNumParams() QualType holding the parameter types.
5272 // Always present. Note that for the vast majority of FunctionProtoType,
5273 // these will be the only trailing objects.
5274 //
5275 // * Optionally if the function is variadic, the SourceLocation of the
5276 // ellipsis.
5277 //
5278 // * Optionally if some extra data is stored in FunctionTypeExtraBitfields
5279 // (see FunctionTypeExtraBitfields and FunctionTypeBitfields):
5280 // a single FunctionTypeExtraBitfields. Present if and only if
5281 // hasExtraBitfields() is true.
5282 //
5283 // * Optionally exactly one of:
5284 // * an array of getNumExceptions() ExceptionType,
5285 // * a single Expr *,
5286 // * a pair of FunctionDecl *,
5287 // * a single FunctionDecl *
5288 // used to store information about the various types of exception
5289 // specification. See getExceptionSpecSize for the details.
5290 //
5291 // * Optionally an array of getNumParams() ExtParameterInfo holding
5292 // an ExtParameterInfo for each of the parameters. Present if and
5293 // only if hasExtParameterInfos() is true.
5294 //
5295 // * Optionally a Qualifiers object to represent extra qualifiers that can't
5296 // be represented by FunctionTypeBitfields.FastTypeQuals. Present if and
5297 // only if hasExtQualifiers() is true.
5298 //
5299 // * Optionally, an array of getNumFunctionEffects() FunctionEffect.
5300 // Present only when getNumFunctionEffects() > 0
5301 //
5302 // * Optionally, an array of getNumFunctionEffects() EffectConditionExpr.
5303 // Present only when getNumFunctionEffectConditions() > 0.
5304 //
5305 // The optional FunctionTypeExtraBitfields has to be before the data
5306 // related to the exception specification since it contains the number
5307 // of exception types.
5308 //
5309 // We put the ExtParameterInfos later. If all were equal, it would make
5310 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
5311 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
5312 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
5313 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
5314 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
5315
5316public:
5317 /// Holds information about the various types of exception specification.
5318 /// ExceptionSpecInfo is not stored as such in FunctionProtoType but is
5319 /// used to group together the various bits of information about the
5320 /// exception specification.
5322 /// The kind of exception specification this is.
5324
5325 /// Explicitly-specified list of exception types.
5327
5328 /// Noexcept expression, if this is a computed noexcept specification.
5329 Expr *NoexceptExpr = nullptr;
5330
5331 /// The function whose exception specification this is, for
5332 /// EST_Unevaluated and EST_Uninstantiated.
5334
5335 /// The function template whose exception specification this is instantiated
5336 /// from, for EST_Uninstantiated.
5338
5340
5342
5343 void instantiate();
5344 };
5345
5346 /// Extra information about a function prototype. ExtProtoInfo is not
5347 /// stored as such in FunctionProtoType but is used to group together
5348 /// the various bits of extra information about a function prototype.
5358
5359 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
5361 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
5362 unsigned HasTrailingReturn : 1;
5363 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
5365 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(AArch64SMETypeAttributes)
5367
5371
5375
5377 ExtProtoInfo Result(*this);
5378 Result.ExceptionSpec = ESI;
5379 return Result;
5380 }
5381
5383 ExtProtoInfo Result(*this);
5384 Result.CFIUncheckedCallee = CFIUncheckedCallee;
5385 return Result;
5386 }
5387
5394
5398
5400 return static_cast<bool>(ExtraAttributeInfo);
5401 }
5402
5403 void setArmSMEAttribute(AArch64SMETypeAttributes Kind, bool Enable = true) {
5404 if (Enable)
5405 AArch64SMEAttributes |= Kind;
5406 else
5407 AArch64SMEAttributes &= ~Kind;
5408 }
5409 };
5410
5411private:
5412 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<QualType>) const {
5413 return getNumParams();
5414 }
5415
5416 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<SourceLocation>) const {
5417 return isVariadic();
5418 }
5419
5420 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionTypeArmAttributes>) const {
5421 return hasArmTypeAttributes();
5422 }
5423
5424 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>) const {
5425 return hasExtraBitfields();
5426 }
5427
5428 unsigned
5429 numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo>) const {
5430 return hasExtraAttributeInfo();
5431 }
5432
5433 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<ExceptionType>) const {
5434 return getExceptionSpecSize().NumExceptionType;
5435 }
5436
5437 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<Expr *>) const {
5438 return getExceptionSpecSize().NumExprPtr;
5439 }
5440
5441 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionDecl *>) const {
5442 return getExceptionSpecSize().NumFunctionDeclPtr;
5443 }
5444
5445 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<ExtParameterInfo>) const {
5446 return hasExtParameterInfos() ? getNumParams() : 0;
5447 }
5448
5449 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<Qualifiers>) const {
5450 return hasExtQualifiers() ? 1 : 0;
5451 }
5452
5453 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionEffect>) const {
5454 return getNumFunctionEffects();
5455 }
5456
5457 /// Determine whether there are any argument types that
5458 /// contain an unexpanded parameter pack.
5459 static bool containsAnyUnexpandedParameterPack(const QualType *ArgArray,
5460 unsigned numArgs) {
5461 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < numArgs; ++Idx)
5462 if (ArgArray[Idx]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
5463 return true;
5464
5465 return false;
5466 }
5467
5468 FunctionProtoType(QualType result, ArrayRef<QualType> params,
5469 QualType canonical, const ExtProtoInfo &epi);
5470
5471 /// This struct is returned by getExceptionSpecSize and is used to
5472 /// translate an ExceptionSpecificationType to the number and kind
5473 /// of trailing objects related to the exception specification.
5474 struct ExceptionSpecSizeHolder {
5475 unsigned NumExceptionType;
5476 unsigned NumExprPtr;
5477 unsigned NumFunctionDeclPtr;
5478 };
5479
5480 /// Return the number and kind of trailing objects
5481 /// related to the exception specification.
5482 static ExceptionSpecSizeHolder
5483 getExceptionSpecSize(ExceptionSpecificationType EST, unsigned NumExceptions) {
5484 switch (EST) {
5485 case EST_None:
5486 case EST_DynamicNone:
5487 case EST_MSAny:
5488 case EST_BasicNoexcept:
5489 case EST_Unparsed:
5490 case EST_NoThrow:
5491 return {0, 0, 0};
5492
5493 case EST_Dynamic:
5494 return {NumExceptions, 0, 0};
5495
5497 case EST_NoexceptFalse:
5498 case EST_NoexceptTrue:
5499 return {0, 1, 0};
5500
5501 case EST_Uninstantiated:
5502 return {0, 0, 2};
5503
5504 case EST_Unevaluated:
5505 return {0, 0, 1};
5506 }
5507 llvm_unreachable("bad exception specification kind");
5508 }
5509
5510 /// Return the number and kind of trailing objects
5511 /// related to the exception specification.
5512 ExceptionSpecSizeHolder getExceptionSpecSize() const {
5513 return getExceptionSpecSize(getExceptionSpecType(), getNumExceptions());
5514 }
5515
5516 /// Whether the trailing FunctionTypeExtraBitfields is present.
5517 bool hasExtraBitfields() const {
5518 assert((getExceptionSpecType() != EST_Dynamic ||
5519 FunctionTypeBits.HasExtraBitfields) &&
5520 "ExtraBitfields are required for given ExceptionSpecType");
5521 return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtraBitfields;
5522
5523 }
5524
5525 bool hasExtraAttributeInfo() const {
5526 return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtraBitfields &&
5527 getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>()
5528 ->HasExtraAttributeInfo;
5529 }
5530
5531 bool hasArmTypeAttributes() const {
5532 return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtraBitfields &&
5533 getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>()
5534 ->HasArmTypeAttributes;
5535 }
5536
5537 bool hasExtQualifiers() const {
5538 return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtQuals;
5539 }
5540
5541public:
5542 unsigned getNumParams() const { return FunctionTypeBits.NumParams; }
5543
5544 QualType getParamType(unsigned i) const {
5545 assert(i < getNumParams() && "invalid parameter index");
5546 return param_type_begin()[i];
5547 }
5548
5552
5569
5570 /// Get the kind of exception specification on this function.
5572 return static_cast<ExceptionSpecificationType>(
5573 FunctionTypeBits.ExceptionSpecType);
5574 }
5575
5576 /// Return whether this function has any kind of exception spec.
5577 bool hasExceptionSpec() const { return getExceptionSpecType() != EST_None; }
5578
5579 /// Return whether this function has a dynamic (throw) exception spec.
5583
5584 /// Return whether this function has a noexcept exception spec.
5588
5589 /// Return whether this function has a dependent exception spec.
5590 bool hasDependentExceptionSpec() const;
5591
5592 /// Return whether this function has an instantiation-dependent exception
5593 /// spec.
5594 bool hasInstantiationDependentExceptionSpec() const;
5595
5596 /// Return all the available information about this type's exception spec.
5600 if (Result.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
5601 Result.Exceptions = exceptions();
5602 } else if (isComputedNoexcept(Result.Type)) {
5603 Result.NoexceptExpr = getNoexceptExpr();
5604 } else if (Result.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
5605 Result.SourceDecl = getExceptionSpecDecl();
5606 Result.SourceTemplate = getExceptionSpecTemplate();
5607 } else if (Result.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
5608 Result.SourceDecl = getExceptionSpecDecl();
5609 }
5610 return Result;
5611 }
5612
5613 /// Return the number of types in the exception specification.
5614 unsigned getNumExceptions() const {
5616 ? getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>()
5617 ->NumExceptionType
5618 : 0;
5619 }
5620
5621 /// Return the ith exception type, where 0 <= i < getNumExceptions().
5622 QualType getExceptionType(unsigned i) const {
5623 assert(i < getNumExceptions() && "Invalid exception number!");
5624 return exception_begin()[i];
5625 }
5626
5627 /// Return the expression inside noexcept(expression), or a null pointer
5628 /// if there is none (because the exception spec is not of this form).
5631 return nullptr;
5632 return *getTrailingObjects<Expr *>();
5633 }
5634
5635 /// If this function type has an exception specification which hasn't
5636 /// been determined yet (either because it has not been evaluated or because
5637 /// it has not been instantiated), this is the function whose exception
5638 /// specification is represented by this type.
5642 return nullptr;
5643 return getTrailingObjects<FunctionDecl *>()[0];
5644 }
5645
5646 /// If this function type has an uninstantiated exception
5647 /// specification, this is the function whose exception specification
5648 /// should be instantiated to find the exception specification for
5649 /// this type.
5652 return nullptr;
5653 return getTrailingObjects<FunctionDecl *>()[1];
5654 }
5655
5656 /// Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception
5657 /// specification.
5658 CanThrowResult canThrow() const;
5659
5660 /// Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception
5661 /// specification. If this depends on template arguments, returns
5662 /// \c ResultIfDependent.
5663 bool isNothrow(bool ResultIfDependent = false) const {
5664 return ResultIfDependent ? canThrow() != CT_Can : canThrow() == CT_Cannot;
5665 }
5666
5667 /// Whether this function prototype is variadic.
5668 bool isVariadic() const { return FunctionTypeBits.Variadic; }
5669
5671 return isVariadic() ? *getTrailingObjects<SourceLocation>()
5672 : SourceLocation();
5673 }
5674
5675 /// Determines whether this function prototype contains a
5676 /// parameter pack at the end.
5677 ///
5678 /// A function template whose last parameter is a parameter pack can be
5679 /// called with an arbitrary number of arguments, much like a variadic
5680 /// function.
5681 bool isTemplateVariadic() const;
5682
5683 /// Whether this function prototype has a trailing return type.
5684 bool hasTrailingReturn() const { return FunctionTypeBits.HasTrailingReturn; }
5685
5687 return FunctionTypeBits.CFIUncheckedCallee;
5688 }
5689
5691 if (hasExtQualifiers())
5692 return *getTrailingObjects<Qualifiers>();
5693 else
5694 return getFastTypeQuals();
5695 }
5696
5697 /// Retrieve the ref-qualifier associated with this function type.
5699 return static_cast<RefQualifierKind>(FunctionTypeBits.RefQualifier);
5700 }
5701
5703
5707
5709 return getTrailingObjects<QualType>();
5710 }
5711
5715
5717
5719 return {exception_begin(), exception_end()};
5720 }
5721
5723 return reinterpret_cast<exception_iterator>(
5724 getTrailingObjects<ExceptionType>());
5725 }
5726
5730
5731 /// Is there any interesting extra information for any of the parameters
5732 /// of this function type?
5734 return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtParameterInfos;
5735 }
5736
5738 assert(hasExtParameterInfos());
5739 return ArrayRef<ExtParameterInfo>(getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>(),
5740 getNumParams());
5741 }
5742
5743 /// Return a pointer to the beginning of the array of extra parameter
5744 /// information, if present, or else null if none of the parameters
5745 /// carry it. This is equivalent to getExtProtoInfo().ExtParameterInfos.
5747 if (!hasExtParameterInfos())
5748 return nullptr;
5749 return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>();
5750 }
5751
5752 /// Return the extra attribute information.
5754 if (hasExtraAttributeInfo())
5755 return *getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo>();
5757 }
5758
5759 /// Return a bitmask describing the SME attributes on the function type, see
5760 /// AArch64SMETypeAttributes for their values.
5761 unsigned getAArch64SMEAttributes() const {
5762 if (!hasArmTypeAttributes())
5763 return SME_NormalFunction;
5764 return getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeArmAttributes>()
5765 ->AArch64SMEAttributes;
5766 }
5767
5769 assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range");
5771 return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I];
5772 return ExtParameterInfo();
5773 }
5774
5775 ParameterABI getParameterABI(unsigned I) const {
5776 assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range");
5778 return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I].getABI();
5780 }
5781
5782 bool isParamConsumed(unsigned I) const {
5783 assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range");
5785 return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I].isConsumed();
5786 return false;
5787 }
5788
5789 unsigned getNumFunctionEffects() const {
5790 return hasExtraBitfields()
5791 ? getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>()
5792 ->NumFunctionEffects
5793 : 0;
5794 }
5795
5796 // For serialization.
5798 if (hasExtraBitfields()) {
5799 const auto *Bitfields = getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>();
5800 if (Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects > 0)
5801 return getTrailingObjects<FunctionEffect>(
5802 Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects);
5803 }
5804 return {};
5805 }
5806
5808 if (hasExtraBitfields()) {
5809 const auto *Bitfields = getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>();
5810 if (Bitfields->EffectsHaveConditions)
5811 return Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects;
5812 }
5813 return 0;
5814 }
5815
5816 // For serialization.
5818 if (hasExtraBitfields()) {
5819 const auto *Bitfields = getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>();
5820 if (Bitfields->EffectsHaveConditions)
5821 return getTrailingObjects<EffectConditionExpr>(
5822 Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects);
5823 }
5824 return {};
5825 }
5826
5827 // Combines effects with their conditions.
5829 if (hasExtraBitfields()) {
5830 const auto *Bitfields = getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>();
5831 if (Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects > 0) {
5832 const size_t NumConds = Bitfields->EffectsHaveConditions
5833 ? Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects
5834 : 0;
5835 return FunctionEffectsRef(
5836 getTrailingObjects<FunctionEffect>(Bitfields->NumFunctionEffects),
5837 {NumConds ? getTrailingObjects<EffectConditionExpr>() : nullptr,
5838 NumConds});
5839 }
5840 }
5841 return {};
5842 }
5843
5844 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
5845 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
5846
5847 void printExceptionSpecification(raw_ostream &OS,
5848 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const;
5849
5850 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
5851 return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionProto;
5852 }
5853
5854 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx);
5855 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Result,
5856 param_type_iterator ArgTys, unsigned NumArgs,
5857 const ExtProtoInfo &EPI, const ASTContext &Context,
5858 bool Canonical);
5859};
5860
5861/// The elaboration keyword that precedes a qualified type name or
5862/// introduces an elaborated-type-specifier.
5864 /// The "struct" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
5866
5867 /// The "__interface" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
5869
5870 /// The "union" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
5872
5873 /// The "class" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
5875
5876 /// The "enum" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
5878
5879 /// The "typename" keyword precedes the qualified type name, e.g.,
5880 /// \c typename T::type.
5882
5883 /// No keyword precedes the qualified type name.
5885};
5886
5887/// The kind of a tag type.
5888enum class TagTypeKind {
5889 /// The "struct" keyword.
5891
5892 /// The "__interface" keyword.
5894
5895 /// The "union" keyword.
5897
5898 /// The "class" keyword.
5900
5901 /// The "enum" keyword.
5903};
5904
5905/// Provides a few static helpers for converting and printing
5906/// elaborated type keyword and tag type kind enumerations.
5908 /// Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into an elaborated type keyword.
5909 static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeywordForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec);
5910
5911 /// Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into a tag type kind.
5912 /// It is an error to provide a type specifier which *isn't* a tag kind here.
5913 static TagTypeKind getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec);
5914
5915 /// Converts a TagTypeKind into an elaborated type keyword.
5917
5918 /// Converts an elaborated type keyword into a TagTypeKind.
5919 /// It is an error to provide an elaborated type keyword
5920 /// which *isn't* a tag kind here.
5922
5924
5926
5927 static StringRef getTagTypeKindName(TagTypeKind Kind) {
5929 }
5930};
5931
5932template <class T> class KeywordWrapper : public T, public KeywordHelpers {
5933protected:
5934 template <class... As>
5936 : T(std::forward<As>(as)...) {
5937 this->KeywordWrapperBits.Keyword = llvm::to_underlying(Keyword);
5938 }
5939
5940public:
5942 return static_cast<ElaboratedTypeKeyword>(this->KeywordWrapperBits.Keyword);
5943 }
5944
5947};
5948
5949/// A helper class for Type nodes having an ElaboratedTypeKeyword.
5950/// The keyword in stored in the free bits of the base class.
5951class TypeWithKeyword : public KeywordWrapper<Type> {
5952protected:
5956};
5957
5958template <class T> struct FoldingSetPlaceholder : llvm::FoldingSetNode {
5959 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { getType()->Profile(ID); }
5960
5961 inline const T *getType() const {
5962 constexpr unsigned long Offset =
5963 llvm::alignTo(sizeof(T), alignof(FoldingSetPlaceholder));
5964 const auto *Addr = reinterpret_cast<const T *>(
5965 reinterpret_cast<const char *>(this) - Offset);
5966 assert(llvm::isAddrAligned(llvm::Align(alignof(T)), Addr));
5967 return Addr;
5968 }
5969};
5970
5971/// Represents the dependent type named by a dependently-scoped
5972/// typename using declaration, e.g.
5973/// using typename Base<T>::foo;
5974///
5975/// Template instantiation turns these into the underlying type.
5976class UnresolvedUsingType final
5977 : public TypeWithKeyword,
5978 private llvm::TrailingObjects<UnresolvedUsingType,
5979 FoldingSetPlaceholder<UnresolvedUsingType>,
5980 NestedNameSpecifier> {
5981 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
5982 friend TrailingObjects;
5983
5985
5986 unsigned numTrailingObjects(
5987 OverloadToken<FoldingSetPlaceholder<UnresolvedUsingType>>) const {
5988 assert(UnresolvedUsingBits.hasQualifier ||
5990 return 1;
5991 }
5992
5993 FoldingSetPlaceholder<UnresolvedUsingType> *getFoldingSetPlaceholder() {
5994 assert(numTrailingObjects(
5996 1);
5997 return getTrailingObjects<FoldingSetPlaceholder<UnresolvedUsingType>>();
5998 }
5999
6000 UnresolvedUsingType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6001 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
6002 const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D,
6003 const Type *CanonicalType);
6004
6005public:
6007 return UnresolvedUsingBits.hasQualifier
6008 ? *getTrailingObjects<NestedNameSpecifier>()
6009 : std::nullopt;
6010 }
6011
6012 UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *getDecl() const { return Decl; }
6013
6014 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
6015 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
6016
6017 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6018 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
6019 const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D) {
6020 static_assert(llvm::to_underlying(ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None) <= 7);
6021 ID.AddInteger(uintptr_t(D) | llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
6022 if (Qualifier)
6023 Qualifier.Profile(ID);
6024 }
6025
6026 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
6028 }
6029
6030 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6031 return T->getTypeClass() == UnresolvedUsing;
6032 }
6033};
6034
6035class UsingType final : public TypeWithKeyword,
6036 public llvm::FoldingSetNode,
6037 llvm::TrailingObjects<UsingType, NestedNameSpecifier> {
6038 UsingShadowDecl *D;
6039 QualType UnderlyingType;
6040
6041 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6042 friend TrailingObjects;
6043
6045 const UsingShadowDecl *D, QualType UnderlyingType);
6046
6047public:
6049 return UsingBits.hasQualifier ? *getTrailingObjects() : std::nullopt;
6050 }
6051
6052 UsingShadowDecl *getDecl() const { return D; }
6053
6054 QualType desugar() const { return UnderlyingType; }
6055 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6056
6057 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6058 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const UsingShadowDecl *D,
6059 QualType UnderlyingType) {
6060 static_assert(llvm::to_underlying(ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None) <= 7);
6061 ID.AddInteger(uintptr_t(D) | llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
6062 UnderlyingType.Profile(ID);
6063 if (Qualifier)
6064 Qualifier.Profile(ID);
6065 }
6066
6067 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
6068 Profile(ID, getKeyword(), getQualifier(), D, desugar());
6069 }
6070 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Using; }
6071};
6072
6073class TypedefType final
6074 : public TypeWithKeyword,
6075 private llvm::TrailingObjects<TypedefType,
6076 FoldingSetPlaceholder<TypedefType>,
6077 NestedNameSpecifier, QualType> {
6078 TypedefNameDecl *Decl;
6079 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6080 friend TrailingObjects;
6081
6082 unsigned
6083 numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FoldingSetPlaceholder<TypedefType>>) const {
6084 assert(TypedefBits.hasQualifier || TypedefBits.hasTypeDifferentFromDecl ||
6086 return 1;
6087 }
6088
6089 unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<NestedNameSpecifier>) const {
6090 return TypedefBits.hasQualifier;
6091 }
6092
6093 TypedefType(TypeClass TC, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6094 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const TypedefNameDecl *D,
6095 QualType UnderlyingType, bool HasTypeDifferentFromDecl);
6096
6097 FoldingSetPlaceholder<TypedefType> *getFoldingSetPlaceholder() {
6098 assert(numTrailingObjects(
6099 OverloadToken<FoldingSetPlaceholder<TypedefType>>{}) == 1);
6100 return getTrailingObjects<FoldingSetPlaceholder<TypedefType>>();
6101 }
6102
6103public:
6105 return TypedefBits.hasQualifier ? *getTrailingObjects<NestedNameSpecifier>()
6106 : std::nullopt;
6107 }
6108
6109 TypedefNameDecl *getDecl() const { return Decl; }
6110
6111 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6112
6113 // This always has the 'same' type as declared, but not necessarily identical.
6114 QualType desugar() const;
6115
6116 // Internal helper, for debugging purposes.
6117 bool typeMatchesDecl() const { return !TypedefBits.hasTypeDifferentFromDecl; }
6118
6119 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6120 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
6121 const TypedefNameDecl *Decl, QualType Underlying) {
6122
6123 ID.AddInteger(uintptr_t(Decl) | (Keyword != ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None) |
6124 (!Qualifier << 1));
6126 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
6127 if (Qualifier)
6128 Qualifier.Profile(ID);
6129 if (!Underlying.isNull())
6130 Underlying.Profile(ID);
6131 }
6132
6133 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
6135 typeMatchesDecl() ? QualType() : desugar());
6136 }
6137
6138 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Typedef; }
6139};
6140
6141/// Sugar type that represents a type that was qualified by a qualifier written
6142/// as a macro invocation.
6143class MacroQualifiedType : public Type {
6144 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6145
6146 QualType UnderlyingTy;
6147 const IdentifierInfo *MacroII;
6148
6149 MacroQualifiedType(QualType UnderlyingTy, QualType CanonTy,
6150 const IdentifierInfo *MacroII)
6151 : Type(MacroQualified, CanonTy, UnderlyingTy->getDependence()),
6152 UnderlyingTy(UnderlyingTy), MacroII(MacroII) {
6153 assert(isa<AttributedType>(UnderlyingTy) &&
6154 "Expected a macro qualified type to only wrap attributed types.");
6155 }
6156
6157public:
6158 const IdentifierInfo *getMacroIdentifier() const { return MacroII; }
6159 QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingTy; }
6160
6161 /// Return this attributed type's modified type with no qualifiers attached to
6162 /// it.
6163 QualType getModifiedType() const;
6164
6165 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6166 QualType desugar() const;
6167
6168 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6169 return T->getTypeClass() == MacroQualified;
6170 }
6171};
6172
6173/// Represents a `typeof` (or __typeof__) expression (a C23 feature and GCC
6174/// extension) or a `typeof_unqual` expression (a C23 feature).
6175class TypeOfExprType : public Type {
6176 Expr *TOExpr;
6177 const ASTContext &Context;
6178
6179protected:
6180 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6181
6182 TypeOfExprType(const ASTContext &Context, Expr *E, TypeOfKind Kind,
6183 QualType Can = QualType());
6184
6185public:
6186 Expr *getUnderlyingExpr() const { return TOExpr; }
6187
6188 /// Returns the kind of 'typeof' type this is.
6190 return static_cast<TypeOfKind>(TypeOfBits.Kind);
6191 }
6192
6193 /// Remove a single level of sugar.
6194 QualType desugar() const;
6195
6196 /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar.
6197 bool isSugared() const;
6198
6199 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == TypeOfExpr; }
6200};
6201
6202/// Internal representation of canonical, dependent
6203/// `typeof(expr)` types.
6204///
6205/// This class is used internally by the ASTContext to manage
6206/// canonical, dependent types, only. Clients will only see instances
6207/// of this class via TypeOfExprType nodes.
6209 public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6210public:
6212 : TypeOfExprType(Context, E, Kind) {}
6213
6214 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
6215 Profile(ID, Context, getUnderlyingExpr(),
6217 }
6218
6219 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
6220 Expr *E, bool IsUnqual);
6221};
6222
6223/// Represents `typeof(type)`, a C23 feature and GCC extension, or
6224/// `typeof_unqual(type), a C23 feature.
6225class TypeOfType : public Type {
6226 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6227
6228 QualType TOType;
6229 const ASTContext &Context;
6230
6231 TypeOfType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType T, QualType Can,
6232 TypeOfKind Kind);
6233
6234public:
6235 QualType getUnmodifiedType() const { return TOType; }
6236
6237 /// Remove a single level of sugar.
6238 QualType desugar() const;
6239
6240 /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar.
6241 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6242
6243 /// Returns the kind of 'typeof' type this is.
6244 TypeOfKind getKind() const {
6245 return static_cast<TypeOfKind>(TypeOfBits.Kind);
6246 }
6247
6248 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == TypeOf; }
6249};
6250
6251/// Represents the type `decltype(expr)` (C++11).
6252class DecltypeType : public Type {
6253 Expr *E;
6254 QualType UnderlyingType;
6255
6256protected:
6257 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6258
6259 DecltypeType(Expr *E, QualType underlyingType, QualType can = QualType());
6260
6261public:
6262 Expr *getUnderlyingExpr() const { return E; }
6263 QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingType; }
6264
6265 /// Remove a single level of sugar.
6266 QualType desugar() const;
6267
6268 /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar.
6269 bool isSugared() const;
6270
6271 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Decltype; }
6272};
6273
6274/// Internal representation of canonical, dependent
6275/// decltype(expr) types.
6276///
6277/// This class is used internally by the ASTContext to manage
6278/// canonical, dependent types, only. Clients will only see instances
6279/// of this class via DecltypeType nodes.
6280class DependentDecltypeType : public DecltypeType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6281public:
6282 DependentDecltypeType(Expr *E);
6283
6284 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
6285 Profile(ID, Context, getUnderlyingExpr());
6286 }
6287
6288 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
6289 Expr *E);
6290};
6291
6292class PackIndexingType final
6293 : public Type,
6294 public llvm::FoldingSetNode,
6295 private llvm::TrailingObjects<PackIndexingType, QualType> {
6296 friend TrailingObjects;
6297
6298 QualType Pattern;
6299 Expr *IndexExpr;
6300
6301 unsigned Size : 31;
6302
6303 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
6304 unsigned FullySubstituted : 1;
6305
6306protected:
6307 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6308 PackIndexingType(QualType Canonical, QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr,
6309 bool FullySubstituted, ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions = {});
6310
6311public:
6312 Expr *getIndexExpr() const { return IndexExpr; }
6313 QualType getPattern() const { return Pattern; }
6314
6315 bool isSugared() const { return hasSelectedType(); }
6316
6317 QualType desugar() const {
6318 if (hasSelectedType())
6319 return getSelectedType();
6320 return QualType(this, 0);
6321 }
6322
6323 QualType getSelectedType() const {
6324 assert(hasSelectedType() && "Type is dependant");
6325 return *(getExpansionsPtr() + *getSelectedIndex());
6326 }
6327
6328 UnsignedOrNone getSelectedIndex() const;
6329
6330 bool hasSelectedType() const { return getSelectedIndex() != std::nullopt; }
6331
6332 bool isFullySubstituted() const { return FullySubstituted; }
6333
6334 bool expandsToEmptyPack() const { return isFullySubstituted() && Size == 0; }
6335
6336 ArrayRef<QualType> getExpansions() const {
6337 return {getExpansionsPtr(), Size};
6338 }
6339
6340 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6341 return T->getTypeClass() == PackIndexing;
6342 }
6343
6344 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context);
6345 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
6346 QualType Pattern, Expr *E, bool FullySubstituted,
6347 ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions);
6348
6349private:
6350 const QualType *getExpansionsPtr() const { return getTrailingObjects(); }
6351
6352 static TypeDependence computeDependence(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr,
6353 ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions = {});
6354};
6355
6356/// A unary type transform, which is a type constructed from another.
6357class UnaryTransformType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6358public:
6359 enum UTTKind {
6360#define TRANSFORM_TYPE_TRAIT_DEF(Enum, _) Enum,
6361#include "clang/Basic/TransformTypeTraits.def"
6362 };
6363
6364private:
6365 /// The untransformed type.
6366 QualType BaseType;
6367
6368 /// The transformed type if not dependent, otherwise the same as BaseType.
6369 QualType UnderlyingType;
6370
6371 UTTKind UKind;
6372
6373protected:
6374 friend class ASTContext;
6375
6376 UnaryTransformType(QualType BaseTy, QualType UnderlyingTy, UTTKind UKind,
6377 QualType CanonicalTy);
6378
6379public:
6380 bool isSugared() const { return !isDependentType(); }
6381 QualType desugar() const { return UnderlyingType; }
6382
6383 QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingType; }
6384 QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; }
6385
6386 UTTKind getUTTKind() const { return UKind; }
6387
6388 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6389 return T->getTypeClass() == UnaryTransform;
6390 }
6391
6392 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6393 Profile(ID, getBaseType(), getUnderlyingType(), getUTTKind());
6394 }
6395
6396 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType BaseType,
6397 QualType UnderlyingType, UTTKind UKind) {
6398 BaseType.Profile(ID);
6399 UnderlyingType.Profile(ID);
6400 ID.AddInteger(UKind);
6401 }
6402};
6403
6404class TagType : public TypeWithKeyword {
6405 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6406
6407 /// Stores the TagDecl associated with this type. The decl may point to any
6408 /// TagDecl that declares the entity.
6409 TagDecl *decl;
6410
6411 void *getTrailingPointer() const;
6412 NestedNameSpecifier &getTrailingQualifier() const;
6413
6414protected:
6415 TagType(TypeClass TC, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6416 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const TagDecl *TD, bool OwnsTag,
6417 bool IsInjected, const Type *CanonicalType);
6418
6419public:
6420 // FIXME: Temporarily renamed from `getDecl` in order to facilitate
6421 // rebasing, due to change in behaviour. This should be renamed back
6422 // to `getDecl` once the change is settled.
6423 TagDecl *getOriginalDecl() const { return decl; }
6424
6425 NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const;
6426
6427 /// Does the TagType own this declaration of the Tag?
6428 bool isTagOwned() const { return TagTypeBits.OwnsTag; }
6429
6430 bool isInjected() const { return TagTypeBits.IsInjected; }
6431
6432 ClassTemplateDecl *getTemplateDecl() const;
6433 TemplateName getTemplateName(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
6434 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> getTemplateArgs(const ASTContext &Ctx) const;
6435
6436 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
6437 QualType desugar() const { return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); }
6438
6439 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6440 return T->getTypeClass() == Enum || T->getTypeClass() == Record ||
6441 T->getTypeClass() == InjectedClassName;
6442 }
6443};
6444
6445struct TagTypeFoldingSetPlaceholder : public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6446 static constexpr size_t getOffset() {
6447 return alignof(TagType) -
6448 (sizeof(TagTypeFoldingSetPlaceholder) % alignof(TagType));
6449 }
6450
6451 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6452 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const TagDecl *Tag,
6453 bool OwnsTag, bool IsInjected) {
6454 ID.AddInteger(uintptr_t(Tag) | OwnsTag | (IsInjected << 1) |
6455 ((Keyword != ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None) << 2));
6456 if (Keyword != ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None)
6457 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
6458 if (Qualifier)
6459 Qualifier.Profile(ID);
6460 }
6461
6462 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
6463 const TagType *T = getTagType();
6464 Profile(ID, T->getKeyword(), T->getQualifier(), T->getOriginalDecl(),
6465 T->isTagOwned(), T->isInjected());
6466 }
6467
6468 TagType *getTagType() {
6469 return reinterpret_cast<TagType *>(reinterpret_cast<char *>(this + 1) +
6470 getOffset());
6471 }
6472 const TagType *getTagType() const {
6473 return const_cast<TagTypeFoldingSetPlaceholder *>(this)->getTagType();
6474 }
6475 static TagTypeFoldingSetPlaceholder *fromTagType(TagType *T) {
6476 return reinterpret_cast<TagTypeFoldingSetPlaceholder *>(
6477 reinterpret_cast<char *>(T) - getOffset()) -
6478 1;
6479 }
6480};
6481
6482/// A helper class that allows the use of isa/cast/dyncast
6483/// to detect TagType objects of structs/unions/classes.
6484class RecordType final : public TagType {
6485 using TagType::TagType;
6486
6487public:
6488 // FIXME: Temporarily renamed from `getDecl` in order to facilitate
6489 // rebasing, due to change in behaviour. This should be renamed back
6490 // to `getDecl` once the change is settled.
6491 RecordDecl *getOriginalDecl() const {
6492 return reinterpret_cast<RecordDecl *>(TagType::getOriginalDecl());
6493 }
6494
6495 /// Recursively check all fields in the record for const-ness. If any field
6496 /// is declared const, return true. Otherwise, return false.
6497 bool hasConstFields() const;
6498
6499 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Record; }
6500};
6501
6502/// A helper class that allows the use of isa/cast/dyncast
6503/// to detect TagType objects of enums.
6504class EnumType final : public TagType {
6505 using TagType::TagType;
6506
6507public:
6508 // FIXME: Temporarily renamed from `getDecl` in order to facilitate
6509 // rebasing, due to change in behaviour. This should be renamed back
6510 // to `getDecl` once the change is settled.
6511 EnumDecl *getOriginalDecl() const {
6512 return reinterpret_cast<EnumDecl *>(TagType::getOriginalDecl());
6513 }
6514
6515 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Enum; }
6516};
6517
6518/// The injected class name of a C++ class template or class
6519/// template partial specialization. Used to record that a type was
6520/// spelled with a bare identifier rather than as a template-id; the
6521/// equivalent for non-templated classes is just RecordType.
6522///
6523/// Injected class name types are always dependent. Template
6524/// instantiation turns these into RecordTypes.
6525///
6526/// Injected class name types are always canonical. This works
6527/// because it is impossible to compare an injected class name type
6528/// with the corresponding non-injected template type, for the same
6529/// reason that it is impossible to directly compare template
6530/// parameters from different dependent contexts: injected class name
6531/// types can only occur within the scope of a particular templated
6532/// declaration, and within that scope every template specialization
6533/// will canonicalize to the injected class name (when appropriate
6534/// according to the rules of the language).
6535class InjectedClassNameType final : public TagType {
6536 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
6537
6538 InjectedClassNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
6539 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const TagDecl *TD,
6540 bool IsInjected, const Type *CanonicalType);
6541
6542public:
6543 // FIXME: Temporarily renamed from `getDecl` in order to facilitate
6544 // rebasing, due to change in behaviour. This should be renamed back
6545 // to `getDecl` once the change is settled.
6546 CXXRecordDecl *getOriginalDecl() const {
6547 return reinterpret_cast<CXXRecordDecl *>(TagType::getOriginalDecl());
6548 }
6549
6550 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6551 return T->getTypeClass() == InjectedClassName;
6552 }
6553};
6554
6555/// An attributed type is a type to which a type attribute has been applied.
6556///
6557/// The "modified type" is the fully-sugared type to which the attributed
6558/// type was applied; generally it is not canonically equivalent to the
6559/// attributed type. The "equivalent type" is the minimally-desugared type
6560/// which the type is canonically equivalent to.
6561///
6562/// For example, in the following attributed type:
6563/// int32_t __attribute__((vector_size(16)))
6564/// - the modified type is the TypedefType for int32_t
6565/// - the equivalent type is VectorType(16, int32_t)
6566/// - the canonical type is VectorType(16, int)
6567class AttributedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6568public:
6569 using Kind = attr::Kind;
6570
6571private:
6572 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
6573
6574 const Attr *Attribute;
6575
6576 QualType ModifiedType;
6577 QualType EquivalentType;
6578
6579 AttributedType(QualType canon, attr::Kind attrKind, QualType modified,
6580 QualType equivalent)
6581 : AttributedType(canon, attrKind, nullptr, modified, equivalent) {}
6582
6583 AttributedType(QualType canon, const Attr *attr, QualType modified,
6584 QualType equivalent);
6585
6586private:
6587 AttributedType(QualType canon, attr::Kind attrKind, const Attr *attr,
6588 QualType modified, QualType equivalent);
6589
6590public:
6591 Kind getAttrKind() const {
6592 return static_cast<Kind>(AttributedTypeBits.AttrKind);
6593 }
6594
6595 const Attr *getAttr() const { return Attribute; }
6596
6597 QualType getModifiedType() const { return ModifiedType; }
6598 QualType getEquivalentType() const { return EquivalentType; }
6599
6600 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6601 QualType desugar() const { return getEquivalentType(); }
6602
6603 /// Does this attribute behave like a type qualifier?
6604 ///
6605 /// A type qualifier adjusts a type to provide specialized rules for
6606 /// a specific object, like the standard const and volatile qualifiers.
6607 /// This includes attributes controlling things like nullability,
6608 /// address spaces, and ARC ownership. The value of the object is still
6609 /// largely described by the modified type.
6610 ///
6611 /// In contrast, many type attributes "rewrite" their modified type to
6612 /// produce a fundamentally different type, not necessarily related in any
6613 /// formalizable way to the original type. For example, calling convention
6614 /// and vector attributes are not simple type qualifiers.
6615 ///
6616 /// Type qualifiers are often, but not always, reflected in the canonical
6617 /// type.
6618 bool isQualifier() const;
6619
6620 bool isMSTypeSpec() const;
6621
6622 bool isWebAssemblyFuncrefSpec() const;
6623
6624 bool isCallingConv() const;
6625
6626 std::optional<NullabilityKind> getImmediateNullability() const;
6627
6628 /// Strip off the top-level nullability annotation on the given
6629 /// type, if it's there.
6630 ///
6631 /// \param T The type to strip. If the type is exactly an
6632 /// AttributedType specifying nullability (without looking through
6633 /// type sugar), the nullability is returned and this type changed
6634 /// to the underlying modified type.
6635 ///
6636 /// \returns the top-level nullability, if present.
6637 static std::optional<NullabilityKind> stripOuterNullability(QualType &T);
6638
6639 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6640 Profile(ID, getAttrKind(), ModifiedType, EquivalentType, Attribute);
6641 }
6642
6643 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, Kind attrKind,
6644 QualType modified, QualType equivalent,
6645 const Attr *attr) {
6646 ID.AddInteger(attrKind);
6647 ID.AddPointer(modified.getAsOpaquePtr());
6648 ID.AddPointer(equivalent.getAsOpaquePtr());
6649 ID.AddPointer(attr);
6650 }
6651
6652 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6653 return T->getTypeClass() == Attributed;
6654 }
6655};
6656
6657class BTFTagAttributedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6658private:
6659 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
6660
6661 QualType WrappedType;
6662 const BTFTypeTagAttr *BTFAttr;
6663
6664 BTFTagAttributedType(QualType Canon, QualType Wrapped,
6665 const BTFTypeTagAttr *BTFAttr)
6666 : Type(BTFTagAttributed, Canon, Wrapped->getDependence()),
6667 WrappedType(Wrapped), BTFAttr(BTFAttr) {}
6668
6669public:
6670 QualType getWrappedType() const { return WrappedType; }
6671 const BTFTypeTagAttr *getAttr() const { return BTFAttr; }
6672
6673 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6674 QualType desugar() const { return getWrappedType(); }
6675
6676 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6677 Profile(ID, WrappedType, BTFAttr);
6678 }
6679
6680 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Wrapped,
6681 const BTFTypeTagAttr *BTFAttr) {
6682 ID.AddPointer(Wrapped.getAsOpaquePtr());
6683 ID.AddPointer(BTFAttr);
6684 }
6685
6686 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6687 return T->getTypeClass() == BTFTagAttributed;
6688 }
6689};
6690
6691class HLSLAttributedResourceType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6692public:
6693 struct Attributes {
6694 // Data gathered from HLSL resource attributes
6695 llvm::dxil::ResourceClass ResourceClass;
6696
6697 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
6698 uint8_t IsROV : 1;
6699
6700 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
6701 uint8_t RawBuffer : 1;
6702
6703 Attributes(llvm::dxil::ResourceClass ResourceClass, bool IsROV = false,
6704 bool RawBuffer = false)
6705 : ResourceClass(ResourceClass), IsROV(IsROV), RawBuffer(RawBuffer) {}
6706
6707 Attributes() : Attributes(llvm::dxil::ResourceClass::UAV, false, false) {}
6708
6709 friend bool operator==(const Attributes &LHS, const Attributes &RHS) {
6710 return std::tie(LHS.ResourceClass, LHS.IsROV, LHS.RawBuffer) ==
6711 std::tie(RHS.ResourceClass, RHS.IsROV, RHS.RawBuffer);
6712 }
6713 friend bool operator!=(const Attributes &LHS, const Attributes &RHS) {
6714 return !(LHS == RHS);
6715 }
6716 };
6717
6718private:
6719 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
6720
6721 QualType WrappedType;
6722 QualType ContainedType;
6723 const Attributes Attrs;
6724
6725 HLSLAttributedResourceType(QualType Wrapped, QualType Contained,
6726 const Attributes &Attrs)
6727 : Type(HLSLAttributedResource, QualType(),
6728 Contained.isNull() ? TypeDependence::None
6729 : Contained->getDependence()),
6730 WrappedType(Wrapped), ContainedType(Contained), Attrs(Attrs) {}
6731
6732public:
6733 QualType getWrappedType() const { return WrappedType; }
6734 QualType getContainedType() const { return ContainedType; }
6735 bool hasContainedType() const { return !ContainedType.isNull(); }
6736 const Attributes &getAttrs() const { return Attrs; }
6737
6738 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
6739 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
6740
6741 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6742 Profile(ID, WrappedType, ContainedType, Attrs);
6743 }
6744
6745 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Wrapped,
6746 QualType Contained, const Attributes &Attrs) {
6747 ID.AddPointer(Wrapped.getAsOpaquePtr());
6748 ID.AddPointer(Contained.getAsOpaquePtr());
6749 ID.AddInteger(static_cast<uint32_t>(Attrs.ResourceClass));
6750 ID.AddBoolean(Attrs.IsROV);
6751 ID.AddBoolean(Attrs.RawBuffer);
6752 }
6753
6754 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6755 return T->getTypeClass() == HLSLAttributedResource;
6756 }
6757
6758 // Returns handle type from HLSL resource, if the type is a resource
6759 static const HLSLAttributedResourceType *
6760 findHandleTypeOnResource(const Type *RT);
6761};
6762
6763/// Instances of this class represent operands to a SPIR-V type instruction.
6764class SpirvOperand {
6765public:
6766 enum SpirvOperandKind : unsigned char {
6767 Invalid, ///< Uninitialized.
6768 ConstantId, ///< Integral value to represent as a SPIR-V OpConstant
6769 ///< instruction ID.
6770 Literal, ///< Integral value to represent as an immediate literal.
6771 TypeId, ///< Type to represent as a SPIR-V type ID.
6772
6773 Max,
6774 };
6775
6776private:
6777 SpirvOperandKind Kind = Invalid;
6778
6779 QualType ResultType;
6780 llvm::APInt Value; // Signedness of constants is represented by ResultType.
6781
6782public:
6783 SpirvOperand() : Kind(Invalid), ResultType(), Value() {}
6784
6785 SpirvOperand(SpirvOperandKind Kind, QualType ResultType, llvm::APInt Value)
6786 : Kind(Kind), ResultType(ResultType), Value(std::move(Value)) {}
6787
6788 SpirvOperand(const SpirvOperand &Other) { *this = Other; }
6789 ~SpirvOperand() {}
6790
6791 SpirvOperand &operator=(const SpirvOperand &Other) = default;
6792
6793 bool operator==(const SpirvOperand &Other) const {
6794 return Kind == Other.Kind && ResultType == Other.ResultType &&
6795 Value == Other.Value;
6796 }
6797
6798 bool operator!=(const SpirvOperand &Other) const { return !(*this == Other); }
6799
6800 SpirvOperandKind getKind() const { return Kind; }
6801
6802 bool isValid() const { return Kind != Invalid && Kind < Max; }
6803 bool isConstant() const { return Kind == ConstantId; }
6804 bool isLiteral() const { return Kind == Literal; }
6805 bool isType() const { return Kind == TypeId; }
6806
6807 llvm::APInt getValue() const {
6808 assert((isConstant() || isLiteral()) &&
6809 "This is not an operand with a value!");
6810 return Value;
6811 }
6812
6813 QualType getResultType() const {
6814 assert((isConstant() || isType()) &&
6815 "This is not an operand with a result type!");
6816 return ResultType;
6817 }
6818
6819 static SpirvOperand createConstant(QualType ResultType, llvm::APInt Val) {
6820 return SpirvOperand(ConstantId, ResultType, std::move(Val));
6821 }
6822
6823 static SpirvOperand createLiteral(llvm::APInt Val) {
6824 return SpirvOperand(Literal, QualType(), std::move(Val));
6825 }
6826
6827 static SpirvOperand createType(QualType T) {
6828 return SpirvOperand(TypeId, T, llvm::APSInt());
6829 }
6830
6831 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
6832 ID.AddInteger(Kind);
6833 ID.AddPointer(ResultType.getAsOpaquePtr());
6834 Value.Profile(ID);
6835 }
6836};
6837
6838/// Represents an arbitrary, user-specified SPIR-V type instruction.
6839class HLSLInlineSpirvType final
6840 : public Type,
6841 public llvm::FoldingSetNode,
6842 private llvm::TrailingObjects<HLSLInlineSpirvType, SpirvOperand> {
6843 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
6844 friend TrailingObjects;
6845
6846private:
6848 uint32_t Size;
6849 uint32_t Alignment;
6850 size_t NumOperands;
6851
6852 HLSLInlineSpirvType(uint32_t Opcode, uint32_t Size, uint32_t Alignment,
6853 ArrayRef<SpirvOperand> Operands)
6854 : Type(HLSLInlineSpirv, QualType(), TypeDependence::None), Opcode(Opcode),
6855 Size(Size), Alignment(Alignment), NumOperands(Operands.size()) {
6856 for (size_t I = 0; I < NumOperands; I++) {
6857 // Since Operands are stored as a trailing object, they have not been
6858 // initialized yet. Call the constructor manually.
6859 auto *Operand = new (&getTrailingObjects()[I]) SpirvOperand();
6860 *Operand = Operands[I];
6861 }
6862 }
6863
6864public:
6865 uint32_t getOpcode() const { return Opcode; }
6866 uint32_t getSize() const { return Size; }
6867 uint32_t getAlignment() const { return Alignment; }
6868 ArrayRef<SpirvOperand> getOperands() const {
6869 return getTrailingObjects(NumOperands);
6870 }
6871
6872 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
6873 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
6874
6875 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6876 Profile(ID, Opcode, Size, Alignment, getOperands());
6877 }
6878
6879 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, uint32_t Opcode,
6880 uint32_t Size, uint32_t Alignment,
6881 ArrayRef<SpirvOperand> Operands) {
6882 ID.AddInteger(Opcode);
6883 ID.AddInteger(Size);
6884 ID.AddInteger(Alignment);
6885 for (auto &Operand : Operands)
6886 Operand.Profile(ID);
6887 }
6888
6889 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6890 return T->getTypeClass() == HLSLInlineSpirv;
6891 }
6892};
6893
6894class TemplateTypeParmType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
6895 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
6896
6897 // The associated TemplateTypeParmDecl for the non-canonical type.
6898 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl;
6899
6900 TemplateTypeParmType(unsigned D, unsigned I, bool PP,
6901 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl, QualType Canon)
6902 : Type(TemplateTypeParm, Canon,
6903 TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation |
6904 (PP ? TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack : TypeDependence::None)),
6905 TTPDecl(TTPDecl) {
6906 assert(!TTPDecl == Canon.isNull());
6907 TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Depth = D;
6908 TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Index = I;
6909 TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.ParameterPack = PP;
6910 }
6911
6912public:
6913 unsigned getDepth() const { return TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Depth; }
6914 unsigned getIndex() const { return TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Index; }
6915 bool isParameterPack() const {
6916 return TemplateTypeParmTypeBits.ParameterPack;
6917 }
6918
6919 TemplateTypeParmDecl *getDecl() const { return TTPDecl; }
6920
6921 IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const;
6922
6923 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
6924 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
6925
6926 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6927 Profile(ID, getDepth(), getIndex(), isParameterPack(), getDecl());
6928 }
6929
6930 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, unsigned Depth,
6931 unsigned Index, bool ParameterPack,
6932 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) {
6933 ID.AddInteger(Depth);
6934 ID.AddInteger(Index);
6935 ID.AddBoolean(ParameterPack);
6936 ID.AddPointer(TTPDecl);
6937 }
6938
6939 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
6940 return T->getTypeClass() == TemplateTypeParm;
6941 }
6942};
6943
6944/// Represents the result of substituting a type for a template
6945/// type parameter.
6946///
6947/// Within an instantiated template, all template type parameters have
6948/// been replaced with these. They are used solely to record that a
6949/// type was originally written as a template type parameter;
6950/// therefore they are never canonical.
6951class SubstTemplateTypeParmType final
6952 : public Type,
6953 public llvm::FoldingSetNode,
6954 private llvm::TrailingObjects<SubstTemplateTypeParmType, QualType> {
6955 friend class ASTContext;
6956 friend class llvm::TrailingObjects<SubstTemplateTypeParmType, QualType>;
6957
6958 Decl *AssociatedDecl;
6959
6960 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(QualType Replacement, Decl *AssociatedDecl,
6961 unsigned Index, UnsignedOrNone PackIndex,
6962 bool Final);
6963
6964public:
6965 /// Gets the type that was substituted for the template
6966 /// parameter.
6967 QualType getReplacementType() const {
6968 return SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBits.HasNonCanonicalUnderlyingType
6969 ? *getTrailingObjects()
6970 : getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6971 }
6972
6973 /// A template-like entity which owns the whole pattern being substituted.
6974 /// This will usually own a set of template parameters, or in some
6975 /// cases might even be a template parameter itself.
6976 Decl *getAssociatedDecl() const { return AssociatedDecl; }
6977
6978 /// Gets the template parameter declaration that was substituted for.
6979 const TemplateTypeParmDecl *getReplacedParameter() const;
6980
6981 /// Returns the index of the replaced parameter in the associated declaration.
6982 /// This should match the result of `getReplacedParameter()->getIndex()`.
6983 unsigned getIndex() const { return SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Index; }
6984
6985 // This substitution is Final, which means the substitution is fully
6986 // sugared: it doesn't need to be resugared later.
6987 unsigned getFinal() const { return SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBits.Final; }
6988
6989 UnsignedOrNone getPackIndex() const {
6990 return UnsignedOrNone::fromInternalRepresentation(
6991 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBits.PackIndex);
6992 }
6993
6994 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
6995 QualType desugar() const { return getReplacementType(); }
6996
6997 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
6998 Profile(ID, getReplacementType(), getAssociatedDecl(), getIndex(),
6999 getPackIndex(), getFinal());
7000 }
7001
7002 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Replacement,
7003 const Decl *AssociatedDecl, unsigned Index,
7004 UnsignedOrNone PackIndex, bool Final);
7005
7006 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7007 return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParm;
7008 }
7009};
7010
7011/// Represents the result of substituting a set of types as a template argument
7012/// that needs to be expanded later.
7013///
7014/// These types are always dependent and produced depending on the situations:
7015/// - SubstTemplateTypeParmPack is an expansion that had to be delayed,
7016/// - SubstBuiltinTemplatePackType is an expansion from a builtin.
7017class SubstPackType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7018 friend class ASTContext;
7019
7020 /// A pointer to the set of template arguments that this
7021 /// parameter pack is instantiated with.
7022 const TemplateArgument *Arguments;
7023
7024protected:
7025 SubstPackType(TypeClass Derived, QualType Canon,
7026 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
7027
7028public:
7029 unsigned getNumArgs() const { return SubstPackTypeBits.NumArgs; }
7030
7031 TemplateArgument getArgumentPack() const;
7032
7033 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
7034 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
7035 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
7036
7037 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7038 return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParmPack ||
7039 T->getTypeClass() == SubstBuiltinTemplatePack;
7040 }
7041};
7042
7043/// Represents the result of substituting a builtin template as a pack.
7044class SubstBuiltinTemplatePackType : public SubstPackType {
7045 friend class ASTContext;
7046
7047 SubstBuiltinTemplatePackType(QualType Canon, const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
7048
7049public:
7050 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7051 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7052
7053 /// Mark that we reuse the Profile. We do not introduce new fields.
7054 using SubstPackType::Profile;
7055
7056 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7057 return T->getTypeClass() == SubstBuiltinTemplatePack;
7058 }
7059};
7060
7061/// Represents the result of substituting a set of types for a template
7062/// type parameter pack.
7063///
7064/// When a pack expansion in the source code contains multiple parameter packs
7065/// and those parameter packs correspond to different levels of template
7066/// parameter lists, this type node is used to represent a template type
7067/// parameter pack from an outer level, which has already had its argument pack
7068/// substituted but that still lives within a pack expansion that itself
7069/// could not be instantiated. When actually performing a substitution into
7070/// that pack expansion (e.g., when all template parameters have corresponding
7071/// arguments), this type will be replaced with the \c SubstTemplateTypeParmType
7072/// at the current pack substitution index.
7073class SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType : public SubstPackType {
7074 friend class ASTContext;
7075
7076 /// A pointer to the set of template arguments that this
7077 /// parameter pack is instantiated with.
7078 const TemplateArgument *Arguments;
7079
7080 llvm::PointerIntPair<Decl *, 1, bool> AssociatedDeclAndFinal;
7081
7082 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(QualType Canon, Decl *AssociatedDecl,
7083 unsigned Index, bool Final,
7084 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
7085
7086public:
7087 IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const;
7088
7089 /// A template-like entity which owns the whole pattern being substituted.
7090 /// This will usually own a set of template parameters, or in some
7091 /// cases might even be a template parameter itself.
7092 Decl *getAssociatedDecl() const;
7093
7094 /// Gets the template parameter declaration that was substituted for.
7095 const TemplateTypeParmDecl *getReplacedParameter() const;
7096
7097 /// Returns the index of the replaced parameter in the associated declaration.
7098 /// This should match the result of `getReplacedParameter()->getIndex()`.
7099 unsigned getIndex() const {
7100 return SubstPackTypeBits.SubstTemplTypeParmPackIndex;
7101 }
7102
7103 // This substitution will be Final, which means the substitution will be fully
7104 // sugared: it doesn't need to be resugared later.
7105 bool getFinal() const;
7106
7107 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7108 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7109
7110 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
7111 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const Decl *AssociatedDecl,
7112 unsigned Index, bool Final,
7113 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
7114
7115 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7116 return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParmPack;
7117 }
7118};
7119
7120/// Common base class for placeholders for types that get replaced by
7121/// placeholder type deduction: C++11 auto, C++14 decltype(auto), C++17 deduced
7122/// class template types, and constrained type names.
7123///
7124/// These types are usually a placeholder for a deduced type. However, before
7125/// the initializer is attached, or (usually) if the initializer is
7126/// type-dependent, there is no deduced type and the type is canonical. In
7127/// the latter case, it is also a dependent type.
7128class DeducedType : public Type {
7129 QualType DeducedAsType;
7130
7131protected:
7132 DeducedType(TypeClass TC, QualType DeducedAsType,
7133 TypeDependence ExtraDependence, QualType Canon)
7134 : Type(TC, Canon,
7135 ExtraDependence | (DeducedAsType.isNull()
7137 : DeducedAsType->getDependence() &
7138 ~TypeDependence::VariablyModified)),
7139 DeducedAsType(DeducedAsType) {}
7140
7141public:
7142 bool isSugared() const { return !DeducedAsType.isNull(); }
7143 QualType desugar() const {
7144 return isSugared() ? DeducedAsType : QualType(this, 0);
7145 }
7146
7147 /// Get the type deduced for this placeholder type, or null if it
7148 /// has not been deduced.
7149 QualType getDeducedType() const { return DeducedAsType; }
7150 bool isDeduced() const {
7151 return !DeducedAsType.isNull() || isDependentType();
7152 }
7153
7154 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7155 return T->getTypeClass() == Auto ||
7156 T->getTypeClass() == DeducedTemplateSpecialization;
7157 }
7158};
7159
7160/// Represents a C++11 auto or C++14 decltype(auto) type, possibly constrained
7161/// by a type-constraint.
7162class AutoType : public DeducedType {
7163 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
7164
7165 TemplateDecl *TypeConstraintConcept;
7166
7167 AutoType(QualType DeducedAsType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
7168 TypeDependence ExtraDependence, QualType Canon, TemplateDecl *CD,
7169 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs);
7170
7171public:
7172 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> getTypeConstraintArguments() const {
7173 return {reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgument *>(this + 1),
7174 AutoTypeBits.NumArgs};
7175 }
7176
7177 TemplateDecl *getTypeConstraintConcept() const {
7178 return TypeConstraintConcept;
7179 }
7180
7181 bool isConstrained() const {
7182 return TypeConstraintConcept != nullptr;
7183 }
7184
7185 bool isDecltypeAuto() const {
7186 return getKeyword() == AutoTypeKeyword::DecltypeAuto;
7187 }
7188
7189 bool isGNUAutoType() const {
7190 return getKeyword() == AutoTypeKeyword::GNUAutoType;
7191 }
7192
7193 AutoTypeKeyword getKeyword() const {
7194 return (AutoTypeKeyword)AutoTypeBits.Keyword;
7195 }
7196
7197 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context);
7198 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
7199 QualType Deduced, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
7200 bool IsDependent, TemplateDecl *CD,
7201 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Arguments);
7202
7203 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7204 return T->getTypeClass() == Auto;
7205 }
7206};
7207
7208/// Represents a C++17 deduced template specialization type.
7209class DeducedTemplateSpecializationType : public KeywordWrapper<DeducedType>,
7210 public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7211 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
7212
7213 /// The name of the template whose arguments will be deduced.
7215
7216 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
7217 TemplateName Template,
7218 QualType DeducedAsType,
7219 bool IsDeducedAsDependent, QualType Canon)
7220 : KeywordWrapper(Keyword, DeducedTemplateSpecialization, DeducedAsType,
7221 toTypeDependence(Template.getDependence()) |
7222 (IsDeducedAsDependent
7223 ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation
7224 : TypeDependence::None),
7225 Canon),
7226 Template(Template) {}
7227
7228public:
7229 /// Retrieve the name of the template that we are deducing.
7230 TemplateName getTemplateName() const { return Template; }
7231
7232 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
7233 Profile(ID, getKeyword(), getTemplateName(), getDeducedType(),
7234 isDependentType());
7235 }
7236
7237 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
7238 TemplateName Template, QualType Deduced,
7239 bool IsDependent) {
7240 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
7241 Template.Profile(ID);
7242 Deduced.Profile(ID);
7243 ID.AddBoolean(IsDependent || Template.isDependent());
7244 }
7245
7246 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7247 return T->getTypeClass() == DeducedTemplateSpecialization;
7248 }
7249};
7250
7251/// Represents a type template specialization; the template
7252/// must be a class template, a type alias template, or a template
7253/// template parameter. A template which cannot be resolved to one of
7254/// these, e.g. because it is written with a dependent scope
7255/// specifier, is instead represented as a
7256/// @c DependentTemplateSpecializationType.
7257///
7258/// A non-dependent template specialization type is always "sugar",
7259/// typically for a \c RecordType. For example, a class template
7260/// specialization type of \c vector<int> will refer to a tag type for
7261/// the instantiation \c std::vector<int, std::allocator<int>>
7262///
7263/// Template specializations are dependent if either the template or
7264/// any of the template arguments are dependent, in which case the
7265/// type may also be canonical.
7266///
7267/// Instances of this type are allocated with a trailing array of
7268/// TemplateArguments, followed by a QualType representing the
7269/// non-canonical aliased type when the template is a type alias
7270/// template.
7271class TemplateSpecializationType : public TypeWithKeyword,
7272 public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7273 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
7274
7275 /// The name of the template being specialized. This is
7276 /// either a TemplateName::Template (in which case it is a
7277 /// ClassTemplateDecl*, a TemplateTemplateParmDecl*, or a
7278 /// TypeAliasTemplateDecl*), a
7279 /// TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack, or a
7280 /// TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm (in which case the
7281 /// replacement must, recursively, be one of these).
7283
7284 TemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, TemplateName T,
7285 bool IsAlias, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
7286 QualType Underlying);
7287
7288public:
7289 /// Determine whether any of the given template arguments are dependent.
7290 ///
7291 /// The converted arguments should be supplied when known; whether an
7292 /// argument is dependent can depend on the conversions performed on it
7293 /// (for example, a 'const int' passed as a template argument might be
7294 /// dependent if the parameter is a reference but non-dependent if the
7295 /// parameter is an int).
7296 ///
7297 /// Note that the \p Args parameter is unused: this is intentional, to remind
7298 /// the caller that they need to pass in the converted arguments, not the
7299 /// specified arguments.
7300 static bool
7301 anyDependentTemplateArguments(ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args,
7302 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Converted);
7303 static bool
7304 anyDependentTemplateArguments(const TemplateArgumentListInfo &,
7305 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Converted);
7306 static bool anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments(
7307 ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args);
7308
7309 /// True if this template specialization type matches a current
7310 /// instantiation in the context in which it is found.
7311 bool isCurrentInstantiation() const {
7312 return isa<InjectedClassNameType>(getCanonicalTypeInternal());
7313 }
7314
7315 /// Determine if this template specialization type is for a type alias
7316 /// template that has been substituted.
7317 ///
7318 /// Nearly every template specialization type whose template is an alias
7319 /// template will be substituted. However, this is not the case when
7320 /// the specialization contains a pack expansion but the template alias
7321 /// does not have a corresponding parameter pack, e.g.,
7322 ///
7323 /// \code
7324 /// template<typename T, typename U, typename V> struct S;
7325 /// template<typename T, typename U> using A = S<T, int, U>;
7326 /// template<typename... Ts> struct X {
7327 /// typedef A<Ts...> type; // not a type alias
7328 /// };
7329 /// \endcode
7330 bool isTypeAlias() const { return TemplateSpecializationTypeBits.TypeAlias; }
7331
7332 /// Get the aliased type, if this is a specialization of a type alias
7333 /// template.
7334 QualType getAliasedType() const;
7335
7336 /// Retrieve the name of the template that we are specializing.
7337 TemplateName getTemplateName() const { return Template; }
7338
7339 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> template_arguments() const {
7340 return {reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgument *>(this + 1),
7341 TemplateSpecializationTypeBits.NumArgs};
7342 }
7343
7344 bool isSugared() const;
7345
7346 QualType desugar() const {
7347 return isTypeAlias() ? getAliasedType() : getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7348 }
7349
7350 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx);
7351 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
7352 TemplateName T, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
7353 QualType Underlying, const ASTContext &Context);
7354
7355 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7357 }
7358};
7359
7360/// Print a template argument list, including the '<' and '>'
7361/// enclosing the template arguments.
7362void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS,
7363 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
7364 const PrintingPolicy &Policy,
7365 const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr);
7366
7367void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS,
7368 ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args,
7369 const PrintingPolicy &Policy,
7370 const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr);
7371
7372void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS,
7373 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
7374 const PrintingPolicy &Policy,
7375 const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr);
7376
7377/// Make a best-effort determination of whether the type T can be produced by
7378/// substituting Args into the default argument of Param.
7379bool isSubstitutedDefaultArgument(ASTContext &Ctx, TemplateArgument Arg,
7380 const NamedDecl *Param,
7381 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
7382 unsigned Depth);
7383
7384/// Represents a qualified type name for which the type name is
7385/// dependent.
7386///
7387/// DependentNameType represents a class of dependent types that involve a
7388/// possibly dependent nested-name-specifier (e.g., "T::") followed by a
7389/// name of a type. The DependentNameType may start with a "typename" (for a
7390/// typename-specifier), "class", "struct", "union", or "enum" (for a
7391/// dependent elaborated-type-specifier), or nothing (in contexts where we
7392/// know that we must be referring to a type, e.g., in a base class specifier).
7393/// Typically the nested-name-specifier is dependent, but in MSVC compatibility
7394/// mode, this type is used with non-dependent names to delay name lookup until
7395/// instantiation.
7396class DependentNameType : public TypeWithKeyword, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7397 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
7398
7399 /// The nested name specifier containing the qualifier.
7400 NestedNameSpecifier NNS;
7401
7402 /// The type that this typename specifier refers to.
7403 const IdentifierInfo *Name;
7404
7405 DependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier NNS,
7406 const IdentifierInfo *Name, QualType CanonType)
7407 : TypeWithKeyword(Keyword, DependentName, CanonType,
7408 TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation |
7409 (NNS ? toTypeDependence(NNS.getDependence())
7411 NNS(NNS), Name(Name) {
7412 assert(Name);
7413 }
7414
7415public:
7416 /// Retrieve the qualification on this type.
7417 NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const { return NNS; }
7418
7419 /// Retrieve the identifier that terminates this type name.
7420 /// For example, "type" in "typename T::type".
7421 const IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const {
7422 return Name;
7423 }
7424
7425 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7426 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7427
7428 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
7429 Profile(ID, getKeyword(), NNS, Name);
7430 }
7431
7432 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
7433 NestedNameSpecifier NNS, const IdentifierInfo *Name) {
7434 ID.AddInteger(llvm::to_underlying(Keyword));
7435 NNS.Profile(ID);
7436 ID.AddPointer(Name);
7437 }
7438
7439 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7440 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentName;
7441 }
7442};
7443
7444/// Represents a pack expansion of types.
7445///
7446/// Pack expansions are part of C++11 variadic templates. A pack
7447/// expansion contains a pattern, which itself contains one or more
7448/// "unexpanded" parameter packs. When instantiated, a pack expansion
7449/// produces a series of types, each instantiated from the pattern of
7450/// the expansion, where the Ith instantiation of the pattern uses the
7451/// Ith arguments bound to each of the unexpanded parameter packs. The
7452/// pack expansion is considered to "expand" these unexpanded
7453/// parameter packs.
7454///
7455/// \code
7456/// template<typename ...Types> struct tuple;
7457///
7458/// template<typename ...Types>
7459/// struct tuple_of_references {
7460/// typedef tuple<Types&...> type;
7461/// };
7462/// \endcode
7463///
7464/// Here, the pack expansion \c Types&... is represented via a
7465/// PackExpansionType whose pattern is Types&.
7466class PackExpansionType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7467 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
7468
7469 /// The pattern of the pack expansion.
7470 QualType Pattern;
7471
7472 PackExpansionType(QualType Pattern, QualType Canon,
7473 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions)
7474 : Type(PackExpansion, Canon,
7475 (Pattern->getDependence() | TypeDependence::Dependent |
7476 TypeDependence::Instantiation) &
7477 ~TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack),
7478 Pattern(Pattern) {
7479 PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions =
7480 NumExpansions ? *NumExpansions + 1 : 0;
7481 }
7482
7483public:
7484 /// Retrieve the pattern of this pack expansion, which is the
7485 /// type that will be repeatedly instantiated when instantiating the
7486 /// pack expansion itself.
7487 QualType getPattern() const { return Pattern; }
7488
7489 /// Retrieve the number of expansions that this pack expansion will
7490 /// generate, if known.
7491 UnsignedOrNone getNumExpansions() const {
7492 if (PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions)
7493 return PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions - 1;
7494 return std::nullopt;
7495 }
7496
7497 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7498 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7499
7500 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
7501 Profile(ID, getPattern(), getNumExpansions());
7502 }
7503
7504 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pattern,
7505 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions) {
7506 ID.AddPointer(Pattern.getAsOpaquePtr());
7507 ID.AddInteger(NumExpansions.toInternalRepresentation());
7508 }
7509
7510 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7511 return T->getTypeClass() == PackExpansion;
7512 }
7513};
7514
7515/// This class wraps the list of protocol qualifiers. For types that can
7516/// take ObjC protocol qualifers, they can subclass this class.
7517template <class T>
7518class ObjCProtocolQualifiers {
7519protected:
7520 ObjCProtocolQualifiers() = default;
7521
7522 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *getProtocolStorage() const {
7523 return const_cast<ObjCProtocolQualifiers*>(this)->getProtocolStorage();
7524 }
7525
7526 ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorage() {
7527 return static_cast<T*>(this)->getProtocolStorageImpl();
7528 }
7529
7530 void setNumProtocols(unsigned N) {
7531 static_cast<T*>(this)->setNumProtocolsImpl(N);
7532 }
7533
7534 void initialize(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols) {
7535 setNumProtocols(protocols.size());
7536 assert(getNumProtocols() == protocols.size() &&
7537 "bitfield overflow in protocol count");
7538 if (!protocols.empty())
7539 memcpy(getProtocolStorage(), protocols.data(),
7540 protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl*));
7541 }
7542
7543public:
7544 using qual_iterator = ObjCProtocolDecl * const *;
7545 using qual_range = llvm::iterator_range<qual_iterator>;
7546
7547 qual_range quals() const { return qual_range(qual_begin(), qual_end()); }
7548 qual_iterator qual_begin() const { return getProtocolStorage(); }
7549 qual_iterator qual_end() const { return qual_begin() + getNumProtocols(); }
7550
7551 bool qual_empty() const { return getNumProtocols() == 0; }
7552
7553 /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this type, or 0 if
7554 /// there are none.
7555 unsigned getNumProtocols() const {
7556 return static_cast<const T*>(this)->getNumProtocolsImpl();
7557 }
7558
7559 /// Fetch a protocol by index.
7560 ObjCProtocolDecl *getProtocol(unsigned I) const {
7561 assert(I < getNumProtocols() && "Out-of-range protocol access");
7562 return qual_begin()[I];
7563 }
7564
7565 /// Retrieve all of the protocol qualifiers.
7566 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> getProtocols() const {
7567 return ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(qual_begin(), getNumProtocols());
7568 }
7569};
7570
7571/// Represents a type parameter type in Objective C. It can take
7572/// a list of protocols.
7573class ObjCTypeParamType : public Type,
7574 public ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCTypeParamType>,
7575 public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7576 friend class ASTContext;
7577 friend class ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCTypeParamType>;
7578
7579 /// The number of protocols stored on this type.
7580 unsigned NumProtocols : 6;
7581
7582 ObjCTypeParamDecl *OTPDecl;
7583
7584 /// The protocols are stored after the ObjCTypeParamType node. In the
7585 /// canonical type, the list of protocols are sorted alphabetically
7586 /// and uniqued.
7587 ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorageImpl();
7588
7589 /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this interface type,
7590 /// or 0 if there are none.
7591 unsigned getNumProtocolsImpl() const {
7592 return NumProtocols;
7593 }
7594
7595 void setNumProtocolsImpl(unsigned N) {
7596 NumProtocols = N;
7597 }
7598
7599 ObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *D,
7600 QualType can,
7601 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols);
7602
7603public:
7604 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
7605 QualType desugar() const { return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); }
7606
7607 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7608 return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCTypeParam;
7609 }
7610
7611 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
7612 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
7613 const ObjCTypeParamDecl *OTPDecl,
7614 QualType CanonicalType,
7615 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols);
7616
7617 ObjCTypeParamDecl *getDecl() const { return OTPDecl; }
7618};
7619
7620/// Represents a class type in Objective C.
7621///
7622/// Every Objective C type is a combination of a base type, a set of
7623/// type arguments (optional, for parameterized classes) and a list of
7624/// protocols.
7625///
7626/// Given the following declarations:
7627/// \code
7628/// \@class C<T>;
7629/// \@protocol P;
7630/// \endcode
7631///
7632/// 'C' is an ObjCInterfaceType C. It is sugar for an ObjCObjectType
7633/// with base C and no protocols.
7634///
7635/// 'C<P>' is an unspecialized ObjCObjectType with base C and protocol list [P].
7636/// 'C<C*>' is a specialized ObjCObjectType with type arguments 'C*' and no
7637/// protocol list.
7638/// 'C<C*><P>' is a specialized ObjCObjectType with base C, type arguments 'C*',
7639/// and protocol list [P].
7640///
7641/// 'id' is a TypedefType which is sugar for an ObjCObjectPointerType whose
7642/// pointee is an ObjCObjectType with base BuiltinType::ObjCIdType
7643/// and no protocols.
7644///
7645/// 'id<P>' is an ObjCObjectPointerType whose pointee is an ObjCObjectType
7646/// with base BuiltinType::ObjCIdType and protocol list [P]. Eventually
7647/// this should get its own sugar class to better represent the source.
7648class ObjCObjectType : public Type,
7649 public ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCObjectType> {
7650 friend class ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCObjectType>;
7651
7652 // ObjCObjectType.NumTypeArgs - the number of type arguments stored
7653 // after the ObjCObjectPointerType node.
7654 // ObjCObjectType.NumProtocols - the number of protocols stored
7655 // after the type arguments of ObjCObjectPointerType node.
7656 //
7657 // These protocols are those written directly on the type. If
7658 // protocol qualifiers ever become additive, the iterators will need
7659 // to get kindof complicated.
7660 //
7661 // In the canonical object type, these are sorted alphabetically
7662 // and uniqued.
7663
7664 /// Either a BuiltinType or an InterfaceType or sugar for either.
7665 QualType BaseType;
7666
7667 /// Cached superclass type.
7668 mutable llvm::PointerIntPair<const ObjCObjectType *, 1, bool>
7669 CachedSuperClassType;
7670
7671 QualType *getTypeArgStorage();
7672 const QualType *getTypeArgStorage() const {
7673 return const_cast<ObjCObjectType *>(this)->getTypeArgStorage();
7674 }
7675
7676 ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorageImpl();
7677 /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this interface type,
7678 /// or 0 if there are none.
7679 unsigned getNumProtocolsImpl() const {
7680 return ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols;
7681 }
7682 void setNumProtocolsImpl(unsigned N) {
7683 ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols = N;
7684 }
7685
7686protected:
7687 enum Nonce_ObjCInterface { Nonce_ObjCInterface };
7688
7689 ObjCObjectType(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
7690 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
7691 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
7692 bool isKindOf);
7693
7694 ObjCObjectType(enum Nonce_ObjCInterface)
7695 : Type(ObjCInterface, QualType(), TypeDependence::None),
7696 BaseType(QualType(this_(), 0)) {
7697 ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols = 0;
7698 ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs = 0;
7699 ObjCObjectTypeBits.IsKindOf = 0;
7700 }
7701
7702 void computeSuperClassTypeSlow() const;
7703
7704public:
7705 /// Gets the base type of this object type. This is always (possibly
7706 /// sugar for) one of:
7707 /// - the 'id' builtin type (as opposed to the 'id' type visible to the
7708 /// user, which is a typedef for an ObjCObjectPointerType)
7709 /// - the 'Class' builtin type (same caveat)
7710 /// - an ObjCObjectType (currently always an ObjCInterfaceType)
7711 QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; }
7712
7713 bool isObjCId() const {
7714 return getBaseType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId);
7715 }
7716
7717 bool isObjCClass() const {
7718 return getBaseType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
7719 }
7720
7721 bool isObjCUnqualifiedId() const { return qual_empty() && isObjCId(); }
7722 bool isObjCUnqualifiedClass() const { return qual_empty() && isObjCClass(); }
7723 bool isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() const {
7724 if (!qual_empty()) return false;
7725 if (const BuiltinType *T = getBaseType()->getAs<BuiltinType>())
7726 return T->getKind() == BuiltinType::ObjCId ||
7727 T->getKind() == BuiltinType::ObjCClass;
7728 return false;
7729 }
7730 bool isObjCQualifiedId() const { return !qual_empty() && isObjCId(); }
7731 bool isObjCQualifiedClass() const { return !qual_empty() && isObjCClass(); }
7732
7733 /// Gets the interface declaration for this object type, if the base type
7734 /// really is an interface.
7735 ObjCInterfaceDecl *getInterface() const;
7736
7737 /// Determine whether this object type is "specialized", meaning
7738 /// that it has type arguments.
7739 bool isSpecialized() const;
7740
7741 /// Determine whether this object type was written with type arguments.
7742 bool isSpecializedAsWritten() const {
7743 return ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs > 0;
7744 }
7745
7746 /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized", meaning
7747 /// that it has no type arguments.
7748 bool isUnspecialized() const { return !isSpecialized(); }
7749
7750 /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized" as
7751 /// written, meaning that it has no type arguments.
7752 bool isUnspecializedAsWritten() const { return !isSpecializedAsWritten(); }
7753
7754 /// Retrieve the type arguments of this object type (semantically).
7755 ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgs() const;
7756
7757 /// Retrieve the type arguments of this object type as they were
7758 /// written.
7759 ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgsAsWritten() const {
7760 return {getTypeArgStorage(), ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs};
7761 }
7762
7763 /// Whether this is a "__kindof" type as written.
7764 bool isKindOfTypeAsWritten() const { return ObjCObjectTypeBits.IsKindOf; }
7765
7766 /// Whether this ia a "__kindof" type (semantically).
7767 bool isKindOfType() const;
7768
7769 /// Retrieve the type of the superclass of this object type.
7770 ///
7771 /// This operation substitutes any type arguments into the
7772 /// superclass of the current class type, potentially producing a
7773 /// specialization of the superclass type. Produces a null type if
7774 /// there is no superclass.
7775 QualType getSuperClassType() const {
7776 if (!CachedSuperClassType.getInt())
7777 computeSuperClassTypeSlow();
7778
7779 assert(CachedSuperClassType.getInt() && "Superclass not set?");
7780 return QualType(CachedSuperClassType.getPointer(), 0);
7781 }
7782
7783 /// Strip off the Objective-C "kindof" type and (with it) any
7784 /// protocol qualifiers.
7785 QualType stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(const ASTContext &ctx) const;
7786
7787 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7788 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7789
7790 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7791 return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCObject ||
7792 T->getTypeClass() == ObjCInterface;
7793 }
7794};
7795
7796/// A class providing a concrete implementation
7797/// of ObjCObjectType, so as to not increase the footprint of
7798/// ObjCInterfaceType. Code outside of ASTContext and the core type
7799/// system should not reference this type.
7800class ObjCObjectTypeImpl : public ObjCObjectType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7801 friend class ASTContext;
7802
7803 // If anyone adds fields here, ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorage()
7804 // will need to be modified.
7805
7806 ObjCObjectTypeImpl(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
7807 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
7808 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
7809 bool isKindOf)
7810 : ObjCObjectType(Canonical, Base, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf) {}
7811
7812public:
7813 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
7814 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
7815 QualType Base,
7816 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
7817 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
7818 bool isKindOf);
7819};
7820
7821inline QualType *ObjCObjectType::getTypeArgStorage() {
7822 return reinterpret_cast<QualType *>(static_cast<ObjCObjectTypeImpl*>(this)+1);
7823}
7824
7825inline ObjCProtocolDecl **ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorageImpl() {
7826 return reinterpret_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl**>(
7827 getTypeArgStorage() + ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs);
7828}
7829
7830inline ObjCProtocolDecl **ObjCTypeParamType::getProtocolStorageImpl() {
7831 return reinterpret_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl**>(
7832 static_cast<ObjCTypeParamType*>(this)+1);
7833}
7834
7835/// Interfaces are the core concept in Objective-C for object oriented design.
7836/// They basically correspond to C++ classes. There are two kinds of interface
7837/// types: normal interfaces like `NSString`, and qualified interfaces, which
7838/// are qualified with a protocol list like `NSString<NSCopyable, NSAmazing>`.
7839///
7840/// ObjCInterfaceType guarantees the following properties when considered
7841/// as a subtype of its superclass, ObjCObjectType:
7842/// - There are no protocol qualifiers. To reinforce this, code which
7843/// tries to invoke the protocol methods via an ObjCInterfaceType will
7844/// fail to compile.
7845/// - It is its own base type. That is, if T is an ObjCInterfaceType*,
7846/// T->getBaseType() == QualType(T, 0).
7847class ObjCInterfaceType : public ObjCObjectType {
7848 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
7849 friend class ASTReader;
7850 template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader;
7851
7852 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl;
7853
7854 ObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D)
7855 : ObjCObjectType(Nonce_ObjCInterface),
7856 Decl(const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl*>(D)) {}
7857
7858public:
7859 /// Get the declaration of this interface.
7860 ObjCInterfaceDecl *getDecl() const;
7861
7862 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
7863 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
7864
7865 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
7866 return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCInterface;
7867 }
7868
7869 // Nonsense to "hide" certain members of ObjCObjectType within this
7870 // class. People asking for protocols on an ObjCInterfaceType are
7871 // not going to get what they want: ObjCInterfaceTypes are
7872 // guaranteed to have no protocols.
7873 enum {
7879 };
7880};
7881
7882inline ObjCInterfaceDecl *ObjCObjectType::getInterface() const {
7883 QualType baseType = getBaseType();
7884 while (const auto *ObjT = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) {
7885 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(ObjT))
7886 return T->getDecl();
7887
7888 baseType = ObjT->getBaseType();
7889 }
7890
7891 return nullptr;
7892}
7893
7894/// Represents a pointer to an Objective C object.
7895///
7896/// These are constructed from pointer declarators when the pointee type is
7897/// an ObjCObjectType (or sugar for one). In addition, the 'id' and 'Class'
7898/// types are typedefs for these, and the protocol-qualified types 'id<P>'
7899/// and 'Class<P>' are translated into these.
7900///
7901/// Pointers to pointers to Objective C objects are still PointerTypes;
7902/// only the first level of pointer gets it own type implementation.
7903class ObjCObjectPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
7904 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
7905
7906 QualType PointeeType;
7907
7908 ObjCObjectPointerType(QualType Canonical, QualType Pointee)
7909 : Type(ObjCObjectPointer, Canonical, Pointee->getDependence()),
7910 PointeeType(Pointee) {}
7911
7912public:
7913 /// Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer.
7914 /// The result will always be an ObjCObjectType or sugar thereof.
7915 QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
7916
7917 /// Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer. Always returns non-null.
7918 ///
7919 /// This method is equivalent to getPointeeType() except that
7920 /// it discards any typedefs (or other sugar) between this
7921 /// type and the "outermost" object type. So for:
7922 /// \code
7923 /// \@class A; \@protocol P; \@protocol Q;
7924 /// typedef A<P> AP;
7925 /// typedef A A1;
7926 /// typedef A1<P> A1P;
7927 /// typedef A1P<Q> A1PQ;
7928 /// \endcode
7929 /// For 'A*', getObjectType() will return 'A'.
7930 /// For 'A<P>*', getObjectType() will return 'A<P>'.
7931 /// For 'AP*', getObjectType() will return 'A<P>'.
7932 /// For 'A1*', getObjectType() will return 'A'.
7933 /// For 'A1<P>*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<P>'.
7934 /// For 'A1P*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<P>'.
7935 /// For 'A1PQ*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<Q>', because
7936 /// adding protocols to a protocol-qualified base discards the
7937 /// old qualifiers (for now). But if it didn't, getObjectType()
7938 /// would return 'A1P<Q>' (and we'd have to make iterating over
7939 /// qualifiers more complicated).
7941 return PointeeType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7942 }
7943
7944 /// If this pointer points to an Objective C
7945 /// \@interface type, gets the type for that interface. Any protocol
7946 /// qualifiers on the interface are ignored.
7947 ///
7948 /// \return null if the base type for this pointer is 'id' or 'Class'
7949 const ObjCInterfaceType *getInterfaceType() const;
7950
7951 /// If this pointer points to an Objective \@interface
7952 /// type, gets the declaration for that interface.
7953 ///
7954 /// \return null if the base type for this pointer is 'id' or 'Class'
7956 return getObjectType()->getInterface();
7957 }
7958
7959 /// True if this is equivalent to the 'id' type, i.e. if
7960 /// its object type is the primitive 'id' type with no protocols.
7961 bool isObjCIdType() const {
7962 return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedId();
7963 }
7964
7965 /// True if this is equivalent to the 'Class' type,
7966 /// i.e. if its object tive is the primitive 'Class' type with no protocols.
7967 bool isObjCClassType() const {
7968 return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedClass();
7969 }
7970
7971 /// True if this is equivalent to the 'id' or 'Class' type,
7972 bool isObjCIdOrClassType() const {
7973 return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass();
7974 }
7975
7976 /// True if this is equivalent to 'id<P>' for some non-empty set of
7977 /// protocols.
7979 return getObjectType()->isObjCQualifiedId();
7980 }
7981
7982 /// True if this is equivalent to 'Class<P>' for some non-empty set of
7983 /// protocols.
7985 return getObjectType()->isObjCQualifiedClass();
7986 }
7987
7988 /// Whether this is a "__kindof" type.
7989 bool isKindOfType() const { return getObjectType()->isKindOfType(); }
7990
7991 /// Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments.
7992 bool isSpecialized() const { return getObjectType()->isSpecialized(); }
7993
7994 /// Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments.
7996 return getObjectType()->isSpecializedAsWritten();
7997 }
7998
7999 /// Whether this type is unspecialized, meaning that is has no type arguments.
8000 bool isUnspecialized() const { return getObjectType()->isUnspecialized(); }
8001
8002 /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized" as
8003 /// written, meaning that it has no type arguments.
8005
8006 /// Retrieve the type arguments for this type.
8008 return getObjectType()->getTypeArgs();
8009 }
8010
8011 /// Retrieve the type arguments for this type.
8013 return getObjectType()->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
8014 }
8015
8016 /// An iterator over the qualifiers on the object type. Provided
8017 /// for convenience. This will always iterate over the full set of
8018 /// protocols on a type, not just those provided directly.
8019 using qual_iterator = ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator;
8020 using qual_range = llvm::iterator_range<qual_iterator>;
8021
8023
8025 return getObjectType()->qual_begin();
8026 }
8027
8029 return getObjectType()->qual_end();
8030 }
8031
8032 bool qual_empty() const { return getObjectType()->qual_empty(); }
8033
8034 /// Return the number of qualifying protocols on the object type.
8035 unsigned getNumProtocols() const {
8036 return getObjectType()->getNumProtocols();
8037 }
8038
8039 /// Retrieve a qualifying protocol by index on the object type.
8040 ObjCProtocolDecl *getProtocol(unsigned I) const {
8041 return getObjectType()->getProtocol(I);
8042 }
8043
8044 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
8045 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
8046
8047 /// Retrieve the type of the superclass of this object pointer type.
8048 ///
8049 /// This operation substitutes any type arguments into the
8050 /// superclass of the current class type, potentially producing a
8051 /// pointer to a specialization of the superclass type. Produces a
8052 /// null type if there is no superclass.
8053 QualType getSuperClassType() const;
8054
8055 /// Strip off the Objective-C "kindof" type and (with it) any
8056 /// protocol qualifiers.
8057 const ObjCObjectPointerType *stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(
8058 const ASTContext &ctx) const;
8059
8060 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
8061 Profile(ID, getPointeeType());
8062 }
8063
8064 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T) {
8065 ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr());
8066 }
8067
8068 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
8069 return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCObjectPointer;
8070 }
8071};
8072
8073class AtomicType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
8074 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
8075
8076 QualType ValueType;
8077
8078 AtomicType(QualType ValTy, QualType Canonical)
8079 : Type(Atomic, Canonical, ValTy->getDependence()), ValueType(ValTy) {}
8080
8081public:
8082 /// Gets the type contained by this atomic type, i.e.
8083 /// the type returned by performing an atomic load of this atomic type.
8084 QualType getValueType() const { return ValueType; }
8085
8086 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
8087 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
8088
8089 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
8090 Profile(ID, getValueType());
8091 }
8092
8093 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T) {
8094 ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr());
8095 }
8096
8097 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
8098 return T->getTypeClass() == Atomic;
8099 }
8100};
8101
8102/// PipeType - OpenCL20.
8103class PipeType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
8104 friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
8105
8106 QualType ElementType;
8107 bool isRead;
8108
8109 PipeType(QualType elemType, QualType CanonicalPtr, bool isRead)
8110 : Type(Pipe, CanonicalPtr, elemType->getDependence()),
8111 ElementType(elemType), isRead(isRead) {}
8112
8113public:
8114 QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
8115
8116 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
8117
8118 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
8119
8120 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
8122 }
8123
8124 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T, bool isRead) {
8125 ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr());
8126 ID.AddBoolean(isRead);
8127 }
8128
8129 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
8130 return T->getTypeClass() == Pipe;
8131 }
8132
8133 bool isReadOnly() const { return isRead; }
8134};
8135
8136/// A fixed int type of a specified bitwidth.
8137class BitIntType final : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
8138 friend class ASTContext;
8139 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
8140 unsigned IsUnsigned : 1;
8141 unsigned NumBits : 24;
8142
8143protected:
8144 BitIntType(bool isUnsigned, unsigned NumBits);
8145
8146public:
8147 bool isUnsigned() const { return IsUnsigned; }
8148 bool isSigned() const { return !IsUnsigned; }
8149 unsigned getNumBits() const { return NumBits; }
8150
8151 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
8152 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
8153
8154 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
8155 Profile(ID, isUnsigned(), getNumBits());
8156 }
8157
8158 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, bool IsUnsigned,
8159 unsigned NumBits) {
8160 ID.AddBoolean(IsUnsigned);
8161 ID.AddInteger(NumBits);
8162 }
8163
8164 static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == BitInt; }
8165};
8166
8167class DependentBitIntType final : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
8168 friend class ASTContext;
8169 llvm::PointerIntPair<Expr*, 1, bool> ExprAndUnsigned;
8170
8171protected:
8172 DependentBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned, Expr *NumBits);
8173
8174public:
8175 bool isUnsigned() const;
8176 bool isSigned() const { return !isUnsigned(); }
8177 Expr *getNumBitsExpr() const;
8178
8179 bool isSugared() const { return false; }
8180 QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
8181
8182 void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) {
8183 Profile(ID, Context, isUnsigned(), getNumBitsExpr());
8184 }
8185 static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context,
8186 bool IsUnsigned, Expr *NumBitsExpr);
8187
8188 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
8189 return T->getTypeClass() == DependentBitInt;
8190 }
8191};
8192
8193class PredefinedSugarType final : public Type {
8194public:
8195 friend class ASTContext;
8197
8198private:
8199 PredefinedSugarType(Kind KD, const IdentifierInfo *IdentName,
8200 QualType CanonicalType)
8201 : Type(PredefinedSugar, CanonicalType, TypeDependence::None),
8202 Name(IdentName) {
8203 PredefinedSugarTypeBits.Kind = llvm::to_underlying(KD);
8204 }
8205
8206 static StringRef getName(Kind KD);
8207
8208 const IdentifierInfo *Name;
8209
8210public:
8211 bool isSugared() const { return true; }
8212
8214
8215 Kind getKind() const { return Kind(PredefinedSugarTypeBits.Kind); }
8216
8217 const IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const { return Name; }
8218
8219 static bool classof(const Type *T) {
8220 return T->getTypeClass() == PredefinedSugar;
8221 }
8222};
8223
8224/// A qualifier set is used to build a set of qualifiers.
8226public:
8228
8229 /// Collect any qualifiers on the given type and return an
8230 /// unqualified type. The qualifiers are assumed to be consistent
8231 /// with those already in the type.
8233 addFastQualifiers(type.getLocalFastQualifiers());
8234 if (!type.hasLocalNonFastQualifiers())
8235 return type.getTypePtrUnsafe();
8236
8237 const ExtQuals *extQuals = type.getExtQualsUnsafe();
8239 return extQuals->getBaseType();
8240 }
8241
8242 /// Apply the collected qualifiers to the given type.
8243 QualType apply(const ASTContext &Context, QualType QT) const;
8244
8245 /// Apply the collected qualifiers to the given type.
8246 QualType apply(const ASTContext &Context, const Type* T) const;
8247};
8248
8249/// A container of type source information.
8250///
8251/// A client can read the relevant info using TypeLoc wrappers, e.g:
8252/// @code
8253/// TypeLoc TL = TypeSourceInfo->getTypeLoc();
8254/// TL.getBeginLoc().print(OS, SrcMgr);
8255/// @endcode
8256class alignas(8) TypeSourceInfo {
8257 // Contains a memory block after the class, used for type source information,
8258 // allocated by ASTContext.
8259 friend class ASTContext;
8260
8261 QualType Ty;
8262
8263 TypeSourceInfo(QualType ty, size_t DataSize); // implemented in TypeLoc.h
8264
8265public:
8266 /// Return the type wrapped by this type source info.
8267 QualType getType() const { return Ty; }
8268
8269 /// Return the TypeLoc wrapper for the type source info.
8270 TypeLoc getTypeLoc() const; // implemented in TypeLoc.h
8271
8272 /// Override the type stored in this TypeSourceInfo. Use with caution!
8273 void overrideType(QualType T) { Ty = T; }
8274};
8275
8276// Inline function definitions.
8277
8279 SplitQualType desugar =
8280 Ty->getLocallyUnqualifiedSingleStepDesugaredType().split();
8282 return desugar;
8283}
8284
8285inline const Type *QualType::getTypePtr() const {
8286 return getCommonPtr()->BaseType;
8287}
8288
8289inline const Type *QualType::getTypePtrOrNull() const {
8290 return (isNull() ? nullptr : getCommonPtr()->BaseType);
8291}
8292
8293inline bool QualType::isReferenceable() const {
8294 // C++ [defns.referenceable]
8295 // type that is either an object type, a function type that does not have
8296 // cv-qualifiers or a ref-qualifier, or a reference type.
8297 const Type &Self = **this;
8298 if (Self.isObjectType() || Self.isReferenceType())
8299 return true;
8300 if (const auto *F = Self.getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8301 return F->getMethodQuals().empty() && F->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None;
8302
8303 return false;
8304}
8305
8308 return SplitQualType(getTypePtrUnsafe(),
8310
8311 const ExtQuals *eq = getExtQualsUnsafe();
8312 Qualifiers qs = eq->getQualifiers();
8314 return SplitQualType(eq->getBaseType(), qs);
8315}
8316
8318 Qualifiers Quals;
8320 Quals = getExtQualsUnsafe()->getQualifiers();
8322 return Quals;
8323}
8324
8326 Qualifiers quals = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.getLocalQualifiers();
8328 return quals;
8329}
8330
8331inline unsigned QualType::getCVRQualifiers() const {
8332 unsigned cvr = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.getLocalCVRQualifiers();
8333 cvr |= getLocalCVRQualifiers();
8334 return cvr;
8335}
8336
8338 QualType canon = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType;
8340}
8341
8342inline bool QualType::isCanonical() const {
8343 return getTypePtr()->isCanonicalUnqualified();
8344}
8345
8346inline bool QualType::isCanonicalAsParam() const {
8347 if (!isCanonical()) return false;
8348 if (hasLocalQualifiers()) return false;
8349
8350 const Type *T = getTypePtr();
8351 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && T->hasSizedVLAType())
8352 return false;
8353
8354 return !isa<FunctionType>(T) &&
8356}
8357
8358inline bool QualType::isConstQualified() const {
8359 return isLocalConstQualified() ||
8360 getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalConstQualified();
8361}
8362
8364 return isLocalRestrictQualified() ||
8365 getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalRestrictQualified();
8366}
8367
8368
8370 return isLocalVolatileQualified() ||
8371 getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalVolatileQualified();
8372}
8373
8374inline bool QualType::hasQualifiers() const {
8375 return hasLocalQualifiers() ||
8376 getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.hasLocalQualifiers();
8377}
8378
8380 if (!getTypePtr()->getCanonicalTypeInternal().hasLocalQualifiers())
8381 return QualType(getTypePtr(), 0);
8382
8383 return QualType(getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(*this).Ty, 0);
8384}
8385
8387 if (!getTypePtr()->getCanonicalTypeInternal().hasLocalQualifiers())
8388 return split();
8389
8390 return getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(*this);
8391}
8392
8396
8400
8404
8405/// Check if this type has any address space qualifier.
8406inline bool QualType::hasAddressSpace() const {
8407 return getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace();
8408}
8409
8410/// Return the address space of this type.
8412 return getQualifiers().getAddressSpace();
8413}
8414
8415/// Return the gc attribute of this type.
8417 return getQualifiers().getObjCGCAttr();
8418}
8419
8421 if (const auto *PT = t.getAs<PointerType>()) {
8422 if (const auto *FT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>())
8423 return FT->getExtInfo();
8424 } else if (const auto *FT = t.getAs<FunctionType>())
8425 return FT->getExtInfo();
8426
8427 return FunctionType::ExtInfo();
8428}
8429
8433
8434/// Determine whether this type is more
8435/// qualified than the Other type. For example, "const volatile int"
8436/// is more qualified than "const int", "volatile int", and
8437/// "int". However, it is not more qualified than "const volatile
8438/// int".
8440 const ASTContext &Ctx) const {
8441 Qualifiers MyQuals = getQualifiers();
8442 Qualifiers OtherQuals = other.getQualifiers();
8443 return (MyQuals != OtherQuals && MyQuals.compatiblyIncludes(OtherQuals, Ctx));
8444}
8445
8446/// Determine whether this type is at last
8447/// as qualified as the Other type. For example, "const volatile
8448/// int" is at least as qualified as "const int", "volatile int",
8449/// "int", and "const volatile int".
8451 const ASTContext &Ctx) const {
8452 Qualifiers OtherQuals = other.getQualifiers();
8453
8454 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is a void.
8455 if (getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
8456 OtherQuals.removeUnaligned();
8457
8458 return getQualifiers().compatiblyIncludes(OtherQuals, Ctx);
8459}
8460
8461/// If Type is a reference type (e.g., const
8462/// int&), returns the type that the reference refers to ("const
8463/// int"). Otherwise, returns the type itself. This routine is used
8464/// throughout Sema to implement C++ 5p6:
8465///
8466/// If an expression initially has the type "reference to T" (8.3.2,
8467/// 8.5.3), the type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further
8468/// analysis, the expression designates the object or function
8469/// denoted by the reference, and the expression is an lvalue.
8471 if (const auto *RefType = (*this)->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8472 return RefType->getPointeeType();
8473 else
8474 return *this;
8475}
8476
8478 return ((getTypePtr()->isVoidType() && !hasQualifiers()) ||
8479 getTypePtr()->isFunctionType());
8480}
8481
8482/// Tests whether the type is categorized as a fundamental type.
8483///
8484/// \returns True for types specified in C++0x [basic.fundamental].
8485inline bool Type::isFundamentalType() const {
8486 return isVoidType() ||
8487 isNullPtrType() ||
8488 // FIXME: It's really annoying that we don't have an
8489 // 'isArithmeticType()' which agrees with the standard definition.
8491}
8492
8493/// Tests whether the type is categorized as a compound type.
8494///
8495/// \returns True for types specified in C++0x [basic.compound].
8496inline bool Type::isCompoundType() const {
8497 // C++0x [basic.compound]p1:
8498 // Compound types can be constructed in the following ways:
8499 // -- arrays of objects of a given type [...];
8500 return isArrayType() ||
8501 // -- functions, which have parameters of given types [...];
8502 isFunctionType() ||
8503 // -- pointers to void or objects or functions [...];
8504 isPointerType() ||
8505 // -- references to objects or functions of a given type. [...]
8506 isReferenceType() ||
8507 // -- classes containing a sequence of objects of various types, [...];
8508 isRecordType() ||
8509 // -- unions, which are classes capable of containing objects of different
8510 // types at different times;
8511 isUnionType() ||
8512 // -- enumerations, which comprise a set of named constant values. [...];
8513 isEnumeralType() ||
8514 // -- pointers to non-static class members, [...].
8516}
8517
8518inline bool Type::isFunctionType() const {
8519 return isa<FunctionType>(CanonicalType);
8520}
8521
8522inline bool Type::isPointerType() const {
8523 return isa<PointerType>(CanonicalType);
8524}
8525
8527 return isPointerType() || isReferenceType();
8528}
8529
8530inline bool Type::isAnyPointerType() const {
8532}
8533
8534inline bool Type::isSignableType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const {
8536}
8537
8538inline bool Type::isSignablePointerType() const {
8540}
8541
8542inline bool Type::isBlockPointerType() const {
8543 return isa<BlockPointerType>(CanonicalType);
8544}
8545
8546inline bool Type::isReferenceType() const {
8547 return isa<ReferenceType>(CanonicalType);
8548}
8549
8550inline bool Type::isLValueReferenceType() const {
8551 return isa<LValueReferenceType>(CanonicalType);
8552}
8553
8554inline bool Type::isRValueReferenceType() const {
8555 return isa<RValueReferenceType>(CanonicalType);
8556}
8557
8558inline bool Type::isObjectPointerType() const {
8559 // Note: an "object pointer type" is not the same thing as a pointer to an
8560 // object type; rather, it is a pointer to an object type or a pointer to cv
8561 // void.
8562 if (const auto *T = getAs<PointerType>())
8563 return !T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType();
8564 else
8565 return false;
8566}
8567
8569 if (const auto *Fn = getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8570 return Fn->hasCFIUncheckedCallee();
8571 return false;
8572}
8573
8575 QualType Pointee;
8576 if (const auto *PT = getAs<PointerType>())
8577 Pointee = PT->getPointeeType();
8578 else if (const auto *RT = getAs<ReferenceType>())
8579 Pointee = RT->getPointeeType();
8580 else if (const auto *MPT = getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8581 Pointee = MPT->getPointeeType();
8582 else if (const auto *DT = getAs<DecayedType>())
8583 Pointee = DT->getPointeeType();
8584 else
8585 return false;
8586 return Pointee->isCFIUncheckedCalleeFunctionType();
8587}
8588
8589inline bool Type::isFunctionPointerType() const {
8590 if (const auto *T = getAs<PointerType>())
8591 return T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType();
8592 else
8593 return false;
8594}
8595
8597 if (const auto *T = getAs<ReferenceType>())
8598 return T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType();
8599 else
8600 return false;
8601}
8602
8603inline bool Type::isMemberPointerType() const {
8604 return isa<MemberPointerType>(CanonicalType);
8605}
8606
8608 if (const auto *T = getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8609 return T->isMemberFunctionPointer();
8610 else
8611 return false;
8612}
8613
8615 if (const auto *T = getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8616 return T->isMemberDataPointer();
8617 else
8618 return false;
8619}
8620
8621inline bool Type::isArrayType() const {
8622 return isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType);
8623}
8624
8625inline bool Type::isConstantArrayType() const {
8626 return isa<ConstantArrayType>(CanonicalType);
8627}
8628
8629inline bool Type::isIncompleteArrayType() const {
8630 return isa<IncompleteArrayType>(CanonicalType);
8631}
8632
8633inline bool Type::isVariableArrayType() const {
8634 return isa<VariableArrayType>(CanonicalType);
8635}
8636
8637inline bool Type::isArrayParameterType() const {
8638 return isa<ArrayParameterType>(CanonicalType);
8639}
8640
8642 return isa<DependentSizedArrayType>(CanonicalType);
8643}
8644
8645inline bool Type::isBuiltinType() const {
8646 return isa<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType);
8647}
8648
8649inline bool Type::isRecordType() const {
8650 return isa<RecordType>(CanonicalType);
8651}
8652
8653inline bool Type::isEnumeralType() const {
8654 return isa<EnumType>(CanonicalType);
8655}
8656
8657inline bool Type::isAnyComplexType() const {
8658 return isa<ComplexType>(CanonicalType);
8659}
8660
8661inline bool Type::isVectorType() const {
8662 return isa<VectorType>(CanonicalType);
8663}
8664
8665inline bool Type::isExtVectorType() const {
8666 return isa<ExtVectorType>(CanonicalType);
8667}
8668
8669inline bool Type::isExtVectorBoolType() const {
8670 if (!isExtVectorType())
8671 return false;
8672 return cast<ExtVectorType>(CanonicalType)->getElementType()->isBooleanType();
8673}
8674
8676 return isVectorType() || isSveVLSBuiltinType();
8677}
8678
8679inline bool Type::isMatrixType() const {
8680 return isa<MatrixType>(CanonicalType);
8681}
8682
8683inline bool Type::isConstantMatrixType() const {
8684 return isa<ConstantMatrixType>(CanonicalType);
8685}
8686
8688 return isa<DependentAddressSpaceType>(CanonicalType);
8689}
8690
8692 return isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CanonicalType);
8693}
8694
8695inline bool Type::isObjCObjectType() const {
8696 return isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType);
8697}
8698
8700 return isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(CanonicalType) ||
8701 isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType);
8702}
8703
8704inline bool Type::isAtomicType() const {
8705 return isa<AtomicType>(CanonicalType);
8706}
8707
8708inline bool Type::isUndeducedAutoType() const {
8709 return isa<AutoType>(CanonicalType);
8710}
8711
8712inline bool Type::isObjCQualifiedIdType() const {
8713 if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8714 return OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
8715 return false;
8716}
8717
8719 if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8720 return OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType();
8721 return false;
8722}
8723
8724inline bool Type::isObjCIdType() const {
8725 if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8726 return OPT->isObjCIdType();
8727 return false;
8728}
8729
8730inline bool Type::isObjCClassType() const {
8731 if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8732 return OPT->isObjCClassType();
8733 return false;
8734}
8735
8736inline bool Type::isObjCSelType() const {
8737 if (const auto *OPT = getAs<PointerType>())
8738 return OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
8739 return false;
8740}
8741
8742inline bool Type::isObjCBuiltinType() const {
8743 return isObjCIdType() || isObjCClassType() || isObjCSelType();
8744}
8745
8746inline bool Type::isDecltypeType() const {
8747 return isa<DecltypeType>(this);
8748}
8749
8750#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
8751 inline bool Type::is##Id##Type() const { \
8752 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Id); \
8753 }
8754#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
8755
8756inline bool Type::isSamplerT() const {
8757 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
8758}
8759
8760inline bool Type::isEventT() const {
8761 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
8762}
8763
8764inline bool Type::isClkEventT() const {
8765 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
8766}
8767
8768inline bool Type::isQueueT() const {
8769 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
8770}
8771
8772inline bool Type::isReserveIDT() const {
8773 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
8774}
8775
8776inline bool Type::isImageType() const {
8777#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) is##Id##Type() ||
8778 return
8779#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
8780 false; // end boolean or operation
8781}
8782
8783inline bool Type::isPipeType() const {
8784 return isa<PipeType>(CanonicalType);
8785}
8786
8787inline bool Type::isBitIntType() const {
8788 return isa<BitIntType>(CanonicalType);
8789}
8790
8791#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
8792 inline bool Type::is##Id##Type() const { \
8793 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Id); \
8794 }
8795#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
8796
8798#define INTEL_SUBGROUP_AVC_TYPE(ExtType, Id) \
8799 isOCLIntelSubgroupAVC##Id##Type() ||
8800 return
8801#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
8802 false; // end of boolean or operation
8803}
8804
8805inline bool Type::isOCLExtOpaqueType() const {
8806#define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) is##Id##Type() ||
8807 return
8808#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
8809 false; // end of boolean or operation
8810}
8811
8812inline bool Type::isOpenCLSpecificType() const {
8813 return isSamplerT() || isEventT() || isImageType() || isClkEventT() ||
8815}
8816
8817#define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
8818 inline bool Type::is##Id##Type() const { \
8819 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Id); \
8820 }
8821#include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
8822
8824#define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) is##Id##Type() ||
8825 return
8826#include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
8827 false;
8828}
8829
8834
8837}
8838
8839inline bool Type::isHLSLInlineSpirvType() const {
8840 return isa<HLSLInlineSpirvType>(this);
8841}
8842
8843inline bool Type::isTemplateTypeParmType() const {
8844 return isa<TemplateTypeParmType>(CanonicalType);
8845}
8846
8847inline bool Type::isSpecificBuiltinType(unsigned K) const {
8848 if (const BuiltinType *BT = getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
8849 return BT->getKind() == static_cast<BuiltinType::Kind>(K);
8850 }
8851 return false;
8852}
8853
8854inline bool Type::isPlaceholderType() const {
8855 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this))
8856 return BT->isPlaceholderType();
8857 return false;
8858}
8859
8861 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this))
8862 if (BT->isPlaceholderType())
8863 return BT;
8864 return nullptr;
8865}
8866
8867inline bool Type::isSpecificPlaceholderType(unsigned K) const {
8869 return isSpecificBuiltinType(K);
8870}
8871
8873 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this))
8874 return BT->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType();
8875 return false;
8876}
8877
8878inline bool Type::isVoidType() const {
8879 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Void);
8880}
8881
8882inline bool Type::isHalfType() const {
8883 // FIXME: Should we allow complex __fp16? Probably not.
8884 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Half);
8885}
8886
8887inline bool Type::isFloat16Type() const {
8888 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float16);
8889}
8890
8891inline bool Type::isFloat32Type() const {
8892 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float);
8893}
8894
8895inline bool Type::isDoubleType() const {
8896 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double);
8897}
8898
8899inline bool Type::isBFloat16Type() const {
8900 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BFloat16);
8901}
8902
8903inline bool Type::isMFloat8Type() const {
8904 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::MFloat8);
8905}
8906
8907inline bool Type::isFloat128Type() const {
8908 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float128);
8909}
8910
8911inline bool Type::isIbm128Type() const {
8912 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Ibm128);
8913}
8914
8915inline bool Type::isNullPtrType() const {
8916 return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::NullPtr);
8917}
8918
8921
8922inline bool Type::isIntegerType() const {
8923 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType))
8924 return BT->isInteger();
8925 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType)) {
8926 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
8927 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
8928 return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getOriginalDecl()) &&
8929 !IsEnumDeclScoped(ET->getOriginalDecl());
8930 }
8931 return isBitIntType();
8932}
8933
8934inline bool Type::isFixedPointType() const {
8935 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) {
8936 return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortAccum &&
8937 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatULongFract;
8938 }
8939 return false;
8940}
8941
8943 return isFixedPointType() || isIntegerType();
8944}
8945
8949
8951 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) {
8952 return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortAccum &&
8953 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatULongFract;
8954 }
8955 return false;
8956}
8957
8961
8962inline bool Type::isSignedFixedPointType() const {
8963 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) {
8964 return ((BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortAccum &&
8965 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::LongAccum) ||
8966 (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortFract &&
8967 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::LongFract) ||
8968 (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortAccum &&
8969 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatLongAccum) ||
8970 (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortFract &&
8971 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatLongFract));
8972 }
8973 return false;
8974}
8975
8978}
8979
8980inline bool Type::isScalarType() const {
8981 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType))
8982 return BT->getKind() > BuiltinType::Void &&
8983 BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::NullPtr;
8984 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType))
8985 // Enums are scalar types, but only if they are defined. Incomplete enums
8986 // are not treated as scalar types.
8987 return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getOriginalDecl());
8988 return isa<PointerType>(CanonicalType) ||
8989 isa<BlockPointerType>(CanonicalType) ||
8990 isa<MemberPointerType>(CanonicalType) ||
8991 isa<ComplexType>(CanonicalType) ||
8992 isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CanonicalType) ||
8993 isBitIntType();
8994}
8995
8997 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType))
8998 return BT->isInteger();
8999
9000 // Check for a complete enum type; incomplete enum types are not properly an
9001 // enumeration type in the sense required here.
9002 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType))
9003 return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getOriginalDecl());
9004
9005 return isBitIntType();
9006}
9007
9008inline bool Type::isBooleanType() const {
9009 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType))
9010 return BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Bool;
9011 return false;
9012}
9013
9014inline bool Type::isUndeducedType() const {
9015 auto *DT = getContainedDeducedType();
9016 return DT && !DT->isDeduced();
9017}
9018
9019/// Determines whether this is a type for which one can define
9020/// an overloaded operator.
9021inline bool Type::isOverloadableType() const {
9022 if (!isDependentType())
9023 return isRecordType() || isEnumeralType();
9024 return !isArrayType() && !isFunctionType() && !isAnyPointerType() &&
9026}
9027
9028/// Determines whether this type is written as a typedef-name.
9029inline bool Type::isTypedefNameType() const {
9030 if (getAs<TypedefType>())
9031 return true;
9032 if (auto *TST = getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>())
9033 return TST->isTypeAlias();
9034 return false;
9035}
9036
9037/// Determines whether this type can decay to a pointer type.
9038inline bool Type::canDecayToPointerType() const {
9039 return isFunctionType() || (isArrayType() && !isArrayParameterType());
9040}
9041
9046
9048 return isObjCObjectPointerType();
9049}
9050
9052 const Type *type = this;
9053 while (const ArrayType *arrayType = type->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
9054 type = arrayType->getElementType().getTypePtr();
9055 return type;
9056}
9057
9059 const Type *type = this;
9060 if (type->isAnyPointerType())
9061 return type->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
9062 else if (type->isArrayType())
9063 return type->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
9064 return type;
9065}
9066/// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending adress
9067/// spaces into a diagnostic with <<.
9069 LangAS AS) {
9070 PD.AddTaggedVal(llvm::to_underlying(AS),
9072 return PD;
9073}
9074
9075/// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending Qualifiers
9076/// into a diagnostic with <<.
9083
9084/// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending QualType's
9085/// into a diagnostic with <<.
9087 QualType T) {
9088 PD.AddTaggedVal(reinterpret_cast<uint64_t>(T.getAsOpaquePtr()),
9090 return PD;
9091}
9092
9093// Helper class template that is used by Type::getAs to ensure that one does
9094// not try to look through a qualified type to get to an array type.
9095template <typename T>
9097 std::integral_constant<bool, std::is_same<T, ArrayType>::value ||
9098 std::is_base_of<ArrayType, T>::value>;
9099
9100// Member-template getAs<specific type>'.
9101template <typename T> const T *Type::getAs() const {
9102 static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value,
9103 "ArrayType cannot be used with getAs!");
9104
9105 // If this is directly a T type, return it.
9106 if (const auto *Ty = dyn_cast<T>(this))
9107 return Ty;
9108
9109 // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it.
9110 if (!isa<T>(CanonicalType))
9111 return nullptr;
9112
9113 // If this is a typedef for the type, strip the typedef off without
9114 // losing all typedef information.
9116}
9117
9118template <typename T> const T *Type::getAsAdjusted() const {
9119 static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value, "ArrayType cannot be used with getAsAdjusted!");
9120
9121 // If this is directly a T type, return it.
9122 if (const auto *Ty = dyn_cast<T>(this))
9123 return Ty;
9124
9125 // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it.
9126 if (!isa<T>(CanonicalType))
9127 return nullptr;
9128
9129 // Strip off type adjustments that do not modify the underlying nature of the
9130 // type.
9131 const Type *Ty = this;
9132 while (Ty) {
9133 if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Ty))
9134 Ty = A->getModifiedType().getTypePtr();
9135 else if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<BTFTagAttributedType>(Ty))
9136 Ty = A->getWrappedType().getTypePtr();
9137 else if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<HLSLAttributedResourceType>(Ty))
9138 Ty = A->getWrappedType().getTypePtr();
9139 else if (const auto *P = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty))
9140 Ty = P->desugar().getTypePtr();
9141 else if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<AdjustedType>(Ty))
9142 Ty = A->desugar().getTypePtr();
9143 else if (const auto *M = dyn_cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Ty))
9144 Ty = M->desugar().getTypePtr();
9145 else
9146 break;
9147 }
9148
9149 // Just because the canonical type is correct does not mean we can use cast<>,
9150 // since we may not have stripped off all the sugar down to the base type.
9151 return dyn_cast<T>(Ty);
9152}
9153
9155 // If this is directly an array type, return it.
9156 if (const auto *arr = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(this))
9157 return arr;
9158
9159 // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it.
9160 if (!isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType))
9161 return nullptr;
9162
9163 // If this is a typedef for the type, strip the typedef off without
9164 // losing all typedef information.
9166}
9167
9168template <typename T> const T *Type::castAs() const {
9169 static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value,
9170 "ArrayType cannot be used with castAs!");
9171
9172 if (const auto *ty = dyn_cast<T>(this)) return ty;
9173 assert(isa<T>(CanonicalType));
9175}
9176
9178 assert(isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType));
9179 if (const auto *arr = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(this)) return arr;
9181}
9182
9183DecayedType::DecayedType(QualType OriginalType, QualType DecayedPtr,
9184 QualType CanonicalPtr)
9185 : AdjustedType(Decayed, OriginalType, DecayedPtr, CanonicalPtr) {
9186#ifndef NDEBUG
9187 QualType Adjusted = getAdjustedType();
9188 (void)AttributedType::stripOuterNullability(Adjusted);
9189 assert(isa<PointerType>(Adjusted));
9190#endif
9191}
9192
9194 QualType Decayed = getDecayedType();
9195 (void)AttributedType::stripOuterNullability(Decayed);
9196 return cast<PointerType>(Decayed)->getPointeeType();
9197}
9198
9199// Get the decimal string representation of a fixed point type, represented
9200// as a scaled integer.
9201// TODO: At some point, we should change the arguments to instead just accept an
9202// APFixedPoint instead of APSInt and scale.
9203void FixedPointValueToString(SmallVectorImpl<char> &Str, llvm::APSInt Val,
9204 unsigned Scale);
9205
9206inline FunctionEffectsRef FunctionEffectsRef::get(QualType QT) {
9207 const Type *TypePtr = QT.getTypePtr();
9208 while (true) {
9209 if (QualType Pointee = TypePtr->getPointeeType(); !Pointee.isNull())
9210 TypePtr = Pointee.getTypePtr();
9211 else if (TypePtr->isArrayType())
9212 TypePtr = TypePtr->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
9213 else
9214 break;
9215 }
9216 if (const auto *FPT = TypePtr->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9217 return FPT->getFunctionEffects();
9218 return {};
9219}
9220
9221} // namespace clang
9222
9223#endif // LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_BASE_H
#define V(N, I)
Provides definitions for the various language-specific address spaces.
static bool isUnsigned(SValBuilder &SVB, NonLoc Value)
Defines the clang::attr::Kind enum.
Defines the Diagnostic-related interfaces.
static bool isBooleanType(QualType Ty)
llvm::dxil::ResourceClass ResourceClass
static std::optional< NonLoc > getIndex(ProgramStateRef State, const ElementRegion *ER, CharKind CK)
clang::CharUnits operator*(clang::CharUnits::QuantityType Scale, const clang::CharUnits &CU)
Definition CharUnits.h:225
static void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS, StringRef FunctionName, ArrayRef< CounterExpression > Expressions, ArrayRef< CounterMappingRegion > Regions)
static Decl::Kind getKind(const Decl *D)
Defines the ExceptionSpecificationType enumeration and various utility functions.
static QualType getObjectType(APValue::LValueBase B)
Retrieves the "underlying object type" of the given expression, as used by __builtin_object_size.
TokenType getType() const
Returns the token's type, e.g.
Forward-declares and imports various common LLVM datatypes that clang wants to use unqualified.
Defines the clang::LangOptions interface.
llvm::MachO::Record Record
Definition MachO.h:31
#define SM(sm)
static StringRef getIdentifier(const Token &Tok)
Implements a partial diagnostic that can be emitted anwyhere in a DiagnosticBuilder stream.
static QualType getUnderlyingType(const SubRegion *R)
static bool hasAttr(const Decl *D, bool IgnoreImplicitAttr)
Definition SemaCUDA.cpp:109
static RecordDecl * getAsRecordDecl(QualType BaseType, HeuristicResolver &Resolver)
static bool isRecordType(QualType T)
static bool isParameterPack(Expr *PackExpression)
Defines the clang::SourceLocation class and associated facilities.
Defines various enumerations that describe declaration and type specifiers.
static OMPAtomicDirective * Create(const ASTContext &C, SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation EndLoc, ArrayRef< OMPClause * > Clauses, Stmt *AssociatedStmt, Expressions Exprs)
Creates directive with a list of Clauses and 'x', 'v' and 'expr' parts of the atomic construct (see S...
static bool classof(const Stmt *T)
static QualType getPointeeType(const MemRegion *R)
static const TemplateTypeParmDecl * getReplacedParameter(Decl *D, unsigned Index)
Definition Type.cpp:4439
Defines the clang::Visibility enumeration and various utility functions.
__DEVICE__ void * memcpy(void *__a, const void *__b, size_t __c)
__device__ __2f16 b
__device__ __2f16 float __ockl_bool s
__device__ __2f16 float c
Holds long-lived AST nodes (such as types and decls) that can be referred to throughout the semantic ...
Definition ASTContext.h:188
Holds long-lived AST nodes (such as types and decls) that can be referred to throughout the semantic ...
Definition ASTContext.h:188
Represents a type which was implicitly adjusted by the semantic engine for arbitrary reasons.
Definition TypeBase.h:3489
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3517
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Orig, QualType New)
Definition TypeBase.h:3512
AdjustedType(TypeClass TC, QualType OriginalTy, QualType AdjustedTy, QualType CanonicalPtr)
Definition TypeBase.h:3496
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3506
QualType getAdjustedType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3503
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3494
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3508
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3505
QualType getOriginalType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3502
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3897
Represents an array type, per C99 6.7.5.2 - Array Declarators.
Definition TypeBase.h:3720
ArraySizeModifier getSizeModifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3734
Qualifiers getIndexTypeQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3738
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3746
QualType getElementType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3732
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3726
ArrayType(TypeClass tc, QualType et, QualType can, ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq, const Expr *sz=nullptr)
Definition Type.cpp:174
unsigned getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3742
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8093
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8086
QualType getValueType() const
Gets the type contained by this atomic type, i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:8084
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8087
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:8074
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:8089
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8097
Attr - This represents one attribute.
Definition Attr.h:44
bool isSigned() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8148
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8164
BitIntType(bool isUnsigned, unsigned NumBits)
Definition Type.cpp:424
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, bool IsUnsigned, unsigned NumBits)
Definition TypeBase.h:8158
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8151
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:8138
bool isUnsigned() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8147
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:8154
unsigned getNumBits() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8149
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8152
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3557
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3552
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3541
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3565
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee)
Definition TypeBase.h:3561
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3555
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3554
[BoundsSafety] Represents a parent type class for CountAttributedType and similar sugar types that wi...
Definition TypeBase.h:3388
decl_iterator dependent_decl_begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3403
decl_iterator dependent_decl_end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3404
unsigned getNumCoupledDecls() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3406
BoundsAttributedType(TypeClass TC, QualType Wrapped, QualType Canon)
Definition Type.cpp:3981
const TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo * decl_iterator
Definition TypeBase.h:3400
decl_range dependent_decls() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3408
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3398
ArrayRef< TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo > getCoupledDecls() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3412
llvm::iterator_range< decl_iterator > decl_range
Definition TypeBase.h:3401
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3418
ArrayRef< TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo > Decls
Definition TypeBase.h:3392
This class is used for builtin types like 'int'.
Definition TypeBase.h:3164
bool isPlaceholderType() const
Determines whether this type is a placeholder type, i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:3253
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3222
bool isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const
Determines whether this type is a placeholder type other than Overload.
Definition TypeBase.h:3266
bool isSVECount() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3243
bool isSVEBool() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3241
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3223
bool isInteger() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3225
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3198
bool isFloatingPoint() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3237
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3270
bool isSignedInteger() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3229
bool isUnsignedInteger() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3233
Kind getKind() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3212
static bool isPlaceholderTypeKind(Kind K)
Determines whether the given kind corresponds to a placeholder type.
Definition TypeBase.h:3246
StringRef getName(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
Definition Type.cpp:3363
const char * getNameAsCString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
Definition TypeBase.h:3215
Represents a C++ struct/union/class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:258
Complex values, per C99 6.2.5p11.
Definition TypeBase.h:3275
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3287
QualType getElementType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3285
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Element)
Definition TypeBase.h:3294
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3298
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3276
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3288
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3290
Declaration of a C++20 concept.
Represents the canonical version of C arrays with a specified constant size.
Definition TypeBase.h:3758
unsigned getSizeBitWidth() const
Return the bit width of the size type.
Definition TypeBase.h:3821
ConstantArrayType(TypeClass Tc, const ConstantArrayType *ATy, QualType Can)
Definition TypeBase.h:3800
ExternalSize * SizePtr
Definition TypeBase.h:3770
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3859
uint64_t getLimitedSize() const
Return the size zero-extended to uint64_t or UINT64_MAX if the value is larger than UINT64_MAX.
Definition TypeBase.h:3847
bool isZeroSize() const
Return true if the size is zero.
Definition TypeBase.h:3828
int64_t getSExtSize() const
Return the size sign-extended as a uint64_t.
Definition TypeBase.h:3840
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3759
const Expr * getSizeExpr() const
Return a pointer to the size expression.
Definition TypeBase.h:3854
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3882
llvm::APInt getSize() const
Return the constant array size as an APInt.
Definition TypeBase.h:3814
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx)
Definition TypeBase.h:3873
uint64_t getZExtSize() const
Return the size zero-extended as a uint64_t.
Definition TypeBase.h:3834
unsigned getNumColumns() const
Returns the number of columns in the matrix.
Definition TypeBase.h:4392
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType, unsigned NumRows, unsigned NumColumns, TypeClass TypeClass)
Definition TypeBase.h:4414
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:4409
static constexpr unsigned getMaxElementsPerDimension()
Returns the maximum number of elements per dimension.
Definition TypeBase.h:4405
unsigned getNumRows() const
Returns the number of rows in the matrix.
Definition TypeBase.h:4389
unsigned getNumElementsFlattened() const
Returns the number of elements required to embed the matrix into a vector.
Definition TypeBase.h:4395
static constexpr unsigned MaxElementsPerDimension
Definition TypeBase.h:4379
ConstantMatrixType(QualType MatrixElementType, unsigned NRows, unsigned NColumns, QualType CanonElementType)
Definition Type.cpp:378
static constexpr bool isDimensionValid(size_t NumElements)
Returns true if NumElements is a valid matrix dimension.
Definition TypeBase.h:4400
unsigned NumRows
Number of rows and columns.
Definition TypeBase.h:4376
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4423
Represents a sugar type with __counted_by or __sized_by annotations, including their _or_null variant...
Definition TypeBase.h:3436
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3472
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3479
bool isCountInBytes() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3463
Expr * getCountExpr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3462
DynamicCountPointerKind getKind() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3466
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:9193
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3534
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3524
QualType getDecayedType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3530
DeclContext - This is used only as base class of specific decl types that can act as declaration cont...
Definition DeclBase.h:1449
Decl - This represents one declaration (or definition), e.g.
Definition DeclBase.h:86
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:4081
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4071
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4077
SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4072
Expr * getNumBitsExpr() const
Definition Type.cpp:437
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8180
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:8182
DependentBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned, Expr *NumBits)
Definition Type.cpp:428
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8188
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:4038
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4034
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4120
SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4115
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:4124
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:4450
SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4444
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4446
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:6214
DependentTypeOfExprType(const ASTContext &Context, Expr *E, TypeOfKind Kind)
Definition TypeBase.h:6211
Expr * getSizeExpr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4236
VectorKind getVectorKind() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4239
SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4238
QualType getElementType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4237
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4244
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context)
Definition TypeBase.h:4250
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4246
@ ak_addrspace
address space
Definition Diagnostic.h:265
Wrap a function effect's condition expression in another struct so that FunctionProtoType's TrailingO...
Definition TypeBase.h:4984
Expr * getCondition() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4991
bool operator==(const EffectConditionExpr &RHS) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4993
Represents an enum.
Definition Decl.h:4004
This represents one expression.
Definition Expr.h:112
We can encode up to four bits in the low bits of a type pointer, but there are many more type qualifi...
Definition TypeBase.h:1717
Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1754
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const Type *BaseType, Qualifiers Quals)
Definition TypeBase.h:1768
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1764
ExtQuals(const Type *baseType, QualType canon, Qualifiers quals)
Definition TypeBase.h:1738
bool hasObjCGCAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1750
Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1751
bool hasAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1758
const Type * getBaseType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1761
Qualifiers getQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1748
LangAS getAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1759
bool hasObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1753
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4324
bool isAccessorWithinNumElements(char c, bool isNumericAccessor) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4318
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:4266
static int getNumericAccessorIdx(char c)
Definition TypeBase.h:4283
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4327
static int getPointAccessorIdx(char c)
Definition TypeBase.h:4273
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4325
static int getAccessorIdx(char c, bool isNumericAccessor)
Definition TypeBase.h:4311
Represents a function declaration or definition.
Definition Decl.h:1999
Support iteration in parallel through a pair of FunctionEffect and EffectConditionExpr containers.
Definition TypeBase.h:5017
bool operator==(const FunctionEffectIterator &Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5026
bool operator!=(const FunctionEffectIterator &Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5029
FunctionEffectIterator operator++()
Definition TypeBase.h:5033
FunctionEffectIterator(const Container &O, size_t I)
Definition TypeBase.h:5025
FunctionEffectWithCondition operator*() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5038
A mutable set of FunctionEffect::Kind.
Definition TypeBase.h:5118
static FunctionEffectKindSet difference(FunctionEffectKindSet LHS, FunctionEffectKindSet RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:5190
bool contains(const FunctionEffect::Kind EK) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5185
FunctionEffectKindSet(FunctionEffectsRef FX)
Definition TypeBase.h:5172
void insert(FunctionEffectKindSet Set)
Definition TypeBase.h:5182
void insert(FunctionEffectsRef FX)
Definition TypeBase.h:5178
void insert(FunctionEffect Effect)
Definition TypeBase.h:5177
FunctionEffectSet(const FunctionEffectsRef &FX)
Definition TypeBase.h:5207
iterator end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5216
size_t size() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5211
FunctionEffectIterator< FunctionEffectSet > iterator
Definition TypeBase.h:5213
bool insert(const FunctionEffectWithCondition &NewEC, Conflicts &Errs)
Definition Type.cpp:5592
SmallVector< Conflict > Conflicts
Definition TypeBase.h:5232
static FunctionEffectSet getIntersection(FunctionEffectsRef LHS, FunctionEffectsRef RHS)
Definition Type.cpp:5641
static FunctionEffectSet getUnion(FunctionEffectsRef LHS, FunctionEffectsRef RHS, Conflicts &Errs)
Definition Type.cpp:5679
iterator begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5215
Represents an abstract function effect, using just an enumeration describing its kind.
Definition TypeBase.h:4877
Kind kind() const
The kind of the effect.
Definition TypeBase.h:4916
unsigned Flags
Flags describing some behaviors of the effect.
Definition TypeBase.h:4890
static constexpr size_t KindCount
Definition TypeBase.h:4887
friend bool operator<(FunctionEffect LHS, FunctionEffect RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:4977
friend bool operator==(FunctionEffect LHS, FunctionEffect RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:4971
uint32_t toOpaqueInt32() const
For serialization.
Definition TypeBase.h:4922
friend bool operator!=(FunctionEffect LHS, FunctionEffect RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:4974
Kind
Identifies the particular effect.
Definition TypeBase.h:4880
Flags flags() const
Flags describing some behaviors of the effect.
Definition TypeBase.h:4928
StringRef name() const
The description printed in diagnostics, e.g. 'nonblocking'.
Definition Type.cpp:5529
static FunctionEffect fromOpaqueInt32(uint32_t Value)
Definition TypeBase.h:4923
friend raw_ostream & operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, const FunctionEffect &Effect)
Definition TypeBase.h:4948
An immutable set of FunctionEffects and possibly conditions attached to them.
Definition TypeBase.h:5064
ArrayRef< FunctionEffect > effects() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5097
iterator begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5102
ArrayRef< EffectConditionExpr > conditions() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5098
static FunctionEffectsRef create(ArrayRef< FunctionEffect > FX, ArrayRef< EffectConditionExpr > Conds)
Asserts invariants.
Definition Type.cpp:5723
iterator end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5103
FunctionEffectIterator< FunctionEffectsRef > iterator
Definition TypeBase.h:5100
friend bool operator==(const FunctionEffectsRef &LHS, const FunctionEffectsRef &RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:5105
static FunctionEffectsRef get(QualType QT)
Extract the effects from a Type if it is a function, block, or member function pointer,...
Definition TypeBase.h:9206
friend bool operator!=(const FunctionEffectsRef &LHS, const FunctionEffectsRef &RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:5109
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ResultType, ExtInfo Info)
Definition TypeBase.h:4862
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4856
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4868
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:4858
Represents a prototype with parameter type info, e.g.
Definition TypeBase.h:5264
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5845
param_type_iterator param_type_begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5708
unsigned getNumFunctionEffectConditions() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5807
ExtParameterInfo getExtParameterInfo(unsigned I) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5768
ArrayRef< EffectConditionExpr > getFunctionEffectConditions() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5817
ExceptionSpecificationType getExceptionSpecType() const
Get the kind of exception specification on this function.
Definition TypeBase.h:5571
ArrayRef< FunctionEffect > getFunctionEffectsWithoutConditions() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5797
bool isParamConsumed(unsigned I) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5782
exception_iterator exception_end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5727
const ExtParameterInfo * getExtParameterInfosOrNull() const
Return a pointer to the beginning of the array of extra parameter information, if present,...
Definition TypeBase.h:5746
unsigned getNumParams() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5542
bool hasTrailingReturn() const
Whether this function prototype has a trailing return type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5684
ExceptionSpecInfo getExceptionSpecInfo() const
Return all the available information about this type's exception spec.
Definition TypeBase.h:5597
const QualType * param_type_iterator
Definition TypeBase.h:5702
Qualifiers getMethodQuals() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5690
const QualType * exception_iterator
Definition TypeBase.h:5716
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:5850
QualType getParamType(unsigned i) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5544
FunctionEffectsRef getFunctionEffects() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5828
unsigned getAArch64SMEAttributes() const
Return a bitmask describing the SME attributes on the function type, see AArch64SMETypeAttributes for...
Definition TypeBase.h:5761
QualType getExceptionType(unsigned i) const
Return the ith exception type, where 0 <= i < getNumExceptions().
Definition TypeBase.h:5622
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Result, param_type_iterator ArgTys, unsigned NumArgs, const ExtProtoInfo &EPI, const ASTContext &Context, bool Canonical)
SourceLocation getEllipsisLoc() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5670
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:5265
unsigned getNumFunctionEffects() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5789
bool hasCFIUncheckedCallee() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5686
unsigned getNumExceptions() const
Return the number of types in the exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5614
bool hasExceptionSpec() const
Return whether this function has any kind of exception spec.
Definition TypeBase.h:5577
CanThrowResult canThrow() const
Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception specification.
Definition Type.cpp:3846
bool hasDynamicExceptionSpec() const
Return whether this function has a dynamic (throw) exception spec.
Definition TypeBase.h:5580
bool hasNoexceptExceptionSpec() const
Return whether this function has a noexcept exception spec.
Definition TypeBase.h:5585
bool isVariadic() const
Whether this function prototype is variadic.
Definition TypeBase.h:5668
ExtProtoInfo getExtProtoInfo() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5553
Expr * getNoexceptExpr() const
Return the expression inside noexcept(expression), or a null pointer if there is none (because the ex...
Definition TypeBase.h:5629
param_type_iterator param_type_end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5712
FunctionDecl * getExceptionSpecTemplate() const
If this function type has an uninstantiated exception specification, this is the function whose excep...
Definition TypeBase.h:5650
FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo getExtraAttributeInfo() const
Return the extra attribute information.
Definition TypeBase.h:5753
bool isNothrow(bool ResultIfDependent=false) const
Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5663
ArrayRef< QualType > getParamTypes() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5549
ArrayRef< QualType > exceptions() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5718
ParameterABI getParameterABI(unsigned I) const
Definition TypeBase.h:5775
ArrayRef< QualType > param_types() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5704
exception_iterator exception_begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5722
ArrayRef< ExtParameterInfo > getExtParameterInfos() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5737
bool hasExtParameterInfos() const
Is there any interesting extra information for any of the parameters of this function type?
Definition TypeBase.h:5733
RefQualifierKind getRefQualifier() const
Retrieve the ref-qualifier associated with this function type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5698
FunctionDecl * getExceptionSpecDecl() const
If this function type has an exception specification which hasn't been determined yet (either because...
Definition TypeBase.h:5639
A class which abstracts out some details necessary for making a call.
Definition TypeBase.h:4571
ExtInfo withNoCfCheck(bool noCfCheck) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4670
ExtInfo withCallingConv(CallingConv cc) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4683
CallingConv getCC() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4630
ExtInfo withProducesResult(bool producesResult) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4649
ExtInfo(bool noReturn, bool hasRegParm, unsigned regParm, CallingConv cc, bool producesResult, bool noCallerSavedRegs, bool NoCfCheck, bool cmseNSCall)
Definition TypeBase.h:4596
unsigned getRegParm() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4623
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4687
bool getNoCallerSavedRegs() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4619
ExtInfo withNoReturn(bool noReturn) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4642
bool operator==(ExtInfo Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4632
ExtInfo withNoCallerSavedRegs(bool noCallerSavedRegs) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4663
ExtInfo withCmseNSCall(bool cmseNSCall) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4656
ExtInfo withRegParm(unsigned RegParm) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4677
bool operator!=(ExtInfo Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4635
Interesting information about a specific parameter that can't simply be reflected in parameter's type...
Definition TypeBase.h:4486
friend bool operator==(ExtParameterInfo lhs, ExtParameterInfo rhs)
Definition TypeBase.h:4542
friend bool operator!=(ExtParameterInfo lhs, ExtParameterInfo rhs)
Definition TypeBase.h:4546
ExtParameterInfo withHasPassObjectSize() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4519
unsigned char getOpaqueValue() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4535
bool isConsumed() const
Is this parameter considered "consumed" by Objective-C ARC?
Definition TypeBase.h:4508
ParameterABI getABI() const
Return the ABI treatment of this parameter.
Definition TypeBase.h:4499
ExtParameterInfo withIsConsumed(bool consumed) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4509
ExtParameterInfo withIsNoEscape(bool NoEscape) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4526
ExtParameterInfo withABI(ParameterABI kind) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4500
static ExtParameterInfo getFromOpaqueValue(unsigned char data)
Definition TypeBase.h:4536
FunctionType - C99 6.7.5.3 - Function Declarators.
Definition TypeBase.h:4460
ExtInfo getExtInfo() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4816
AArch64SMETypeAttributes
The AArch64 SME ACLE (Arm C/C++ Language Extensions) define a number of function type attributes that...
Definition TypeBase.h:4736
static ArmStateValue getArmZT0State(unsigned AttrBits)
Definition TypeBase.h:4769
bool getNoReturnAttr() const
Determine whether this function type includes the GNU noreturn attribute.
Definition TypeBase.h:4808
bool isConst() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4822
static ArmStateValue getArmZAState(unsigned AttrBits)
Definition TypeBase.h:4765
unsigned getRegParmType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4803
CallingConv getCallConv() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4815
bool isRestrict() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4824
QualType getReturnType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4800
FunctionType(TypeClass tc, QualType res, QualType Canonical, TypeDependence Dependence, ExtInfo Info)
Definition TypeBase.h:4786
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4834
bool getCmseNSCallAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4814
bool getHasRegParm() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4802
Qualifiers getFastTypeQuals() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4792
QualType getCallResultType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Determine the type of an expression that calls a function of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:4828
bool isVolatile() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4823
One of these records is kept for each identifier that is lexed.
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3924
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ET, ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, unsigned TypeQuals)
Definition TypeBase.h:3929
friend class StmtIteratorBase
Definition TypeBase.h:3915
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3918
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3920
KeywordWrapper(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, As &&...as)
Definition TypeBase.h:5935
ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeyword() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5941
static CannotCastToThisType classof(const T *)
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3627
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3625
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:6168
QualType getUnderlyingType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6159
const IdentifierInfo * getMacroIdentifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6158
QualType getElementType() const
Returns type of the elements being stored in the matrix.
Definition TypeBase.h:4349
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:4337
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4362
MatrixType(QualType ElementTy, QualType CanonElementTy)
static bool isValidElementType(QualType T)
Valid elements types are the following:
Definition TypeBase.h:4356
QualType ElementType
The element type of the matrix.
Definition TypeBase.h:4340
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4361
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4364
NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3683
bool isSugared() const
Definition Type.cpp:5435
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3694
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3669
bool isMemberFunctionPointer() const
Returns true if the member type (i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:3673
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3652
bool isMemberDataPointer() const
Returns true if the member type (i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:3679
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3690
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3705
This represents a decl that may have a name.
Definition Decl.h:273
Represents a C++ nested name specifier, such as "\::std::vector<int>::".
Represents an ObjC class declaration.
Definition DeclObjC.h:1154
Represents typeof(type), a C23 feature and GCC extension, or `typeof_unqual(type),...
Definition TypeBase.h:7847
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:7863
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:7848
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:7865
Represents a pointer to an Objective C object.
Definition TypeBase.h:7903
unsigned getNumProtocols() const
Return the number of qualifying protocols on the object type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8035
bool isSpecialized() const
Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments.
Definition TypeBase.h:7992
qual_iterator qual_end() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8028
bool isObjCQualifiedClassType() const
True if this is equivalent to 'Class.
Definition TypeBase.h:7984
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8064
bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const
True if this is equivalent to 'id.
Definition TypeBase.h:7978
bool isSpecializedAsWritten() const
Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments.
Definition TypeBase.h:7995
bool isUnspecializedAsWritten() const
Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized" as written, meaning that it has no type argumen...
Definition TypeBase.h:8004
ArrayRef< QualType > getTypeArgsAsWritten() const
Retrieve the type arguments for this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8012
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:8060
const ObjCObjectType * getObjectType() const
Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer.
Definition TypeBase.h:7940
ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator qual_iterator
An iterator over the qualifiers on the object type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8019
llvm::iterator_range< qual_iterator > qual_range
Definition TypeBase.h:8020
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8068
bool isUnspecialized() const
Whether this type is unspecialized, meaning that is has no type arguments.
Definition TypeBase.h:8000
bool isObjCIdType() const
True if this is equivalent to the 'id' type, i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:7961
ObjCProtocolDecl * getProtocol(unsigned I) const
Retrieve a qualifying protocol by index on the object type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8040
QualType getPointeeType() const
Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer.
Definition TypeBase.h:7915
ObjCInterfaceDecl * getInterfaceDecl() const
If this pointer points to an Objective @interface type, gets the declaration for that interface.
Definition TypeBase.h:7955
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8045
qual_range quals() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8022
bool isObjCClassType() const
True if this is equivalent to the 'Class' type, i.e.
Definition TypeBase.h:7967
bool isObjCIdOrClassType() const
True if this is equivalent to the 'id' or 'Class' type,.
Definition TypeBase.h:7972
ArrayRef< QualType > getTypeArgs() const
Retrieve the type arguments for this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8007
qual_iterator qual_begin() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8024
bool isKindOfType() const
Whether this is a "__kindof" type.
Definition TypeBase.h:7989
Represents an Objective-C protocol declaration.
Definition DeclObjC.h:2084
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3314
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3316
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3303
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3324
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Inner)
Definition TypeBase.h:3320
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3313
QualType getInnerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3311
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8118
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8116
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T, bool isRead)
Definition TypeBase.h:8124
QualType getElementType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8114
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:8120
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8129
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:8104
bool isReadOnly() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8133
Pointer-authentication qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:152
static PointerAuthQualifier fromOpaqueValue(uint32_t Opaque)
Definition TypeBase.h:308
friend bool operator==(PointerAuthQualifier Lhs, PointerAuthQualifier Rhs)
Definition TypeBase.h:294
static PointerAuthQualifier Create(unsigned Key, bool IsAddressDiscriminated, unsigned ExtraDiscriminator, PointerAuthenticationMode AuthenticationMode, bool IsIsaPointer, bool AuthenticatesNullValues)
Definition TypeBase.h:239
friend bool operator!=(PointerAuthQualifier Lhs, PointerAuthQualifier Rhs)
Definition TypeBase.h:297
bool authenticatesNullValues() const
Definition TypeBase.h:285
bool isEquivalent(PointerAuthQualifier Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:301
@ MaxDiscriminator
The maximum supported pointer-authentication discriminator.
Definition TypeBase.h:232
@ MaxKey
The maximum supported pointer-authentication key.
Definition TypeBase.h:229
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:322
bool isAddressDiscriminated() const
Definition TypeBase.h:265
PointerAuthQualifier withoutKeyNone() const
Definition TypeBase.h:290
unsigned getExtraDiscriminator() const
Definition TypeBase.h:270
void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
PointerAuthenticationMode getAuthenticationMode() const
Definition TypeBase.h:275
bool isEmptyWhenPrinted(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
std::string getAsString() const
uint32_t getAsOpaqueValue() const
Definition TypeBase.h:305
unsigned getKey() const
Definition TypeBase.h:258
PointerType - C99 6.7.5.1 - Pointer Declarators.
Definition TypeBase.h:3328
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3338
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3329
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3351
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3341
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3343
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3340
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee)
Definition TypeBase.h:3347
PredefinedSugarKind Kind
Definition TypeBase.h:8196
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:8219
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8213
const IdentifierInfo * getIdentifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8217
StreamedQualTypeHelper(const QualType &T, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder, unsigned Indentation)
Definition TypeBase.h:1376
friend raw_ostream & operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, const StreamedQualTypeHelper &SQT)
Definition TypeBase.h:1381
A (possibly-)qualified type.
Definition TypeBase.h:937
void addRestrict()
Add the restrict qualifier to this QualType.
Definition TypeBase.h:1172
QualType(const ExtQuals *Ptr, unsigned Quals)
Definition TypeBase.h:962
bool hasAddressDiscriminatedPointerAuth() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1457
bool isLocalConstQualified() const
Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the "const" qualifier set,...
Definition TypeBase.h:1014
bool isLocalRestrictQualified() const
Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the "restrict" qualifier set,...
Definition TypeBase.h:1044
bool isVolatileQualified() const
Determine whether this type is volatile-qualified.
Definition TypeBase.h:8369
bool isRestrictQualified() const
Determine whether this type is restrict-qualified.
Definition TypeBase.h:8363
bool isTriviallyCopyableType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if this is a trivially copyable type (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
Definition Type.cpp:2867
QualType IgnoreParens() const
Returns the specified type after dropping any outer-level parentheses.
Definition TypeBase.h:1315
Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const
Returns gc attribute of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8416
friend bool operator==(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS)
Indicate whether the specified types and qualifiers are identical.
Definition TypeBase.h:1322
bool hasQualifiers() const
Determine whether this type has any qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:8374
QualType withFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1201
QualType withRestrict() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1175
bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() const
Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to copy, which is a union that has a membe...
Definition Type.h:87
PointerAuthQualifier getPointerAuth() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1453
void addFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs)
Definition TypeBase.h:1183
bool isWebAssemblyFuncrefType() const
Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Funcref Type.
Definition Type.cpp:2948
QualType getNonLValueExprType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Determine the type of a (typically non-lvalue) expression with the specified result type.
Definition Type.cpp:3556
@ PDIK_ARCWeak
The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified with the ARC __weak qualifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:1475
@ PDIK_Trivial
The type does not fall into any of the following categories.
Definition TypeBase.h:1467
@ PDIK_ARCStrong
The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified with the ARC __strong qualifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:1471
@ PDIK_Struct
The type is a struct containing a field whose type is not PCK_Trivial.
Definition TypeBase.h:1478
bool mayBeDynamicClass() const
Returns true if it is a class and it might be dynamic.
Definition Type.cpp:130
bool hasLocalNonFastQualifiers() const
Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any "non-fast" qualifiers,...
Definition TypeBase.h:1074
bool isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(const ASTContext &Context) const
Definition Type.cpp:2921
const IdentifierInfo * getBaseTypeIdentifier() const
Retrieves a pointer to the name of the base type.
Definition Type.cpp:109
bool isBitwiseCloneableType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if the type is safe to bitwise copy using memcpy/memmove.
Definition Type.cpp:2873
QualType withoutLocalFastQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1214
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1398
bool isAddressSpaceOverlapping(QualType T, const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Returns true if address space qualifiers overlap with T address space qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:1416
QualType getDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from the type.
Definition TypeBase.h:1296
void removeLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:1194
QualType withConst() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1159
QualType getLocalUnqualifiedType() const
Return this type with all of the instance-specific qualifiers removed, but without removing any quali...
Definition TypeBase.h:1225
void addConst()
Add the const type qualifier to this QualType.
Definition TypeBase.h:1156
bool hasLocalQualifiers() const
Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any qualifiers, without looking through any t...
Definition TypeBase.h:1064
bool isTriviallyCopyConstructibleType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if this is a trivially copyable type.
Definition Type.cpp:2915
bool isTrivialType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if this is a trivial type per (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
Definition Type.cpp:2758
bool isNull() const
Return true if this QualType doesn't point to a type yet.
Definition TypeBase.h:1004
PrimitiveCopyKind isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy() const
Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct transitively containing this type to ...
Definition Type.cpp:2970
const Type * getTypePtr() const
Retrieves a pointer to the underlying (unqualified) type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8285
LangAS getAddressSpace() const
Return the address space of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8411
bool isConstant(const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1097
static QualType getFromOpaquePtr(const void *Ptr)
Definition TypeBase.h:986
QualType withVolatile() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1167
bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() const
Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to destruct, which is a union that has a m...
Definition Type.h:81
Qualifiers getQualifiers() const
Retrieve the set of qualifiers applied to this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8325
const Type * operator->() const
Definition TypeBase.h:996
void setLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Quals)
Definition TypeBase.h:965
bool isCXX98PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if this is a POD type according to the rules of the C++98 standard, regardless of the cur...
Definition Type.cpp:2703
Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const
Returns lifetime attribute of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:1438
QualType stripObjCKindOfType(const ASTContext &ctx) const
Strip Objective-C "__kindof" types from the given type.
Definition Type.cpp:1663
void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder=Twine(), unsigned Indentation=0) const
void getAsStringInternal(std::string &Str, const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
bool isReferenceable() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8293
QualType getNonReferenceType() const
If Type is a reference type (e.g., const int&), returns the type that the reference refers to ("const...
Definition TypeBase.h:8470
QualType getCanonicalType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8337
QualType getUnqualifiedType() const
Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type, removing as little sugar as possible.
Definition TypeBase.h:8379
void removeLocalVolatile()
Definition TypeBase.h:8401
QualType substObjCMemberType(QualType objectType, const DeclContext *dc, ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const
Substitute type arguments from an object type for the Objective-C type parameters used in the subject...
Definition Type.cpp:1654
bool isWebAssemblyReferenceType() const
Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Reference Type.
Definition Type.cpp:2940
SplitQualType getSplitDesugaredType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1300
std::optional< NonConstantStorageReason > isNonConstantStorage(const ASTContext &Ctx, bool ExcludeCtor, bool ExcludeDtor)
Determine whether instances of this type can be placed in immutable storage.
Definition Type.cpp:151
QualType withCVRQualifiers(unsigned CVR) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1179
QualType()=default
unsigned getLocalCVRQualifiers() const
Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers local to this particular QualType instan...
Definition TypeBase.h:1089
SplitQualType split() const
Divides a QualType into its unqualified type and a set of local qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:8306
bool UseExcessPrecision(const ASTContext &Ctx)
Definition Type.cpp:1612
void addVolatile()
Add the volatile type qualifier to this QualType.
Definition TypeBase.h:1164
bool isCForbiddenLValueType() const
Determine whether expressions of the given type are forbidden from being lvalues in C.
Definition TypeBase.h:8477
PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize() const
Functions to query basic properties of non-trivial C struct types.
Definition Type.cpp:2954
bool isObjCGCStrong() const
true when Type is objc's strong.
Definition TypeBase.h:1433
std::string getAsString() const
void dump() const
void * getAsOpaquePtr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:984
static void print(SplitQualType split, raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder, unsigned Indentation=0)
Definition TypeBase.h:1346
bool isMoreQualifiedThan(QualType Other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Determine whether this type is more qualified than the other given type, requiring exact equality for...
Definition TypeBase.h:8439
bool isCanonicalAsParam() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8346
void removeLocalConst()
Definition TypeBase.h:8393
void removeLocalRestrict()
Definition TypeBase.h:8397
bool isWebAssemblyExternrefType() const
Returns true if it is a WebAssembly Externref Type.
Definition Type.cpp:2944
QualType(const Type *Ptr, unsigned Quals)
Definition TypeBase.h:961
QualType getNonPackExpansionType() const
Remove an outer pack expansion type (if any) from this type.
Definition Type.cpp:3549
SplitQualType getSplitUnqualifiedType() const
Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type, removing as little sugar as possible.
Definition TypeBase.h:8386
bool isCXX11PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return true if this is a POD type according to the more relaxed rules of the C++11 standard,...
Definition Type.cpp:3112
bool mayBeNotDynamicClass() const
Returns true if it is not a class or if the class might not be dynamic.
Definition Type.cpp:135
bool isConstQualified() const
Determine whether this type is const-qualified.
Definition TypeBase.h:8358
bool hasAddressSpace() const
Check if this type has any address space qualifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:8406
bool isObjCGCWeak() const
true when Type is objc's weak.
Definition TypeBase.h:1428
QualType substObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx, ArrayRef< QualType > typeArgs, ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const
Substitute type arguments for the Objective-C type parameters used in the subject type.
Definition Type.cpp:1647
unsigned getLocalFastQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:964
void removeLocalFastQualifiers()
Definition TypeBase.h:1193
QualType getAtomicUnqualifiedType() const
Remove all qualifiers including _Atomic.
Definition Type.cpp:1670
DestructionKind isDestructedType() const
Returns a nonzero value if objects of this type require non-trivial work to clean up after.
Definition TypeBase.h:1545
friend bool operator<(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:1328
friend bool operator!=(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:1325
bool isCanonical() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8342
StreamedQualTypeHelper stream(const PrintingPolicy &Policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder=Twine(), unsigned Indentation=0) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1388
bool isLocalVolatileQualified() const
Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the "volatile" qualifier set,...
Definition TypeBase.h:1054
bool isConstantStorage(const ASTContext &Ctx, bool ExcludeCtor, bool ExcludeDtor)
Definition TypeBase.h:1036
unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const
Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers applied to this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8331
static void getAsStringInternal(SplitQualType split, std::string &out, const PrintingPolicy &policy)
Definition TypeBase.h:1360
QualType getSingleStepDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Return the specified type with one level of "sugar" removed from the type.
Definition TypeBase.h:1309
const Type * getTypePtrOrNull() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8289
static std::string getAsString(SplitQualType split, const PrintingPolicy &Policy)
Definition TypeBase.h:1332
bool hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1442
bool isPODType(const ASTContext &Context) const
Determine whether this is a Plain Old Data (POD) type (C++ 3.9p10).
Definition Type.cpp:2695
bool isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(QualType Other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Determine whether this type is at least as qualified as the other given type, requiring exact equalit...
Definition TypeBase.h:8450
friend class QualifierCollector
Definition TypeBase.h:938
bool hasStrongOrWeakObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:1446
PrimitiveCopyKind isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructiveMove() const
Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct transitively containing this type to ...
Definition Type.cpp:2990
QualType withExactLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) const
Definition TypeBase.h:1209
@ PCK_Struct
The type is a struct containing a field whose type is neither PCK_Trivial nor PCK_VolatileTrivial.
Definition TypeBase.h:1517
@ PCK_Trivial
The type does not fall into any of the following categories.
Definition TypeBase.h:1493
@ PCK_ARCStrong
The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified with the ARC __strong qualifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:1502
@ PCK_VolatileTrivial
The type would be trivial except that it is volatile-qualified.
Definition TypeBase.h:1498
@ PCK_PtrAuth
The type is an address-discriminated signed pointer type.
Definition TypeBase.h:1509
@ PCK_ARCWeak
The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified with the ARC __weak qualifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:1506
const Type & operator*() const
Definition TypeBase.h:992
Qualifiers getLocalQualifiers() const
Retrieve the set of qualifiers local to this particular QualType instance, not including any qualifie...
Definition TypeBase.h:8317
bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() const
Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to default-initialize, which is a union th...
Definition Type.h:75
const Type * strip(QualType type)
Collect any qualifiers on the given type and return an unqualified type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8232
QualifierCollector(Qualifiers Qs=Qualifiers())
Definition TypeBase.h:8227
QualifiersAndAtomic & operator+=(Qualifiers RHS)
Definition TypeBase.h:862
QualifiersAndAtomic withVolatile()
Definition TypeBase.h:853
QualifiersAndAtomic withAtomic()
Definition TypeBase.h:860
QualifiersAndAtomic withConst()
Definition TypeBase.h:856
QualifiersAndAtomic(Qualifiers Quals, bool HasAtomic)
Definition TypeBase.h:833
QualifiersAndAtomic withRestrict()
Definition TypeBase.h:857
The collection of all-type qualifiers we support.
Definition TypeBase.h:331
unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:488
void removeCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:495
GC getObjCGCAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:519
friend Qualifiers operator-(Qualifiers L, Qualifiers R)
Compute the difference between two qualifier sets.
Definition TypeBase.h:790
static Qualifiers fromFastMask(unsigned Mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:429
void setFastQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:620
void addAddressSpace(LangAS space)
Definition TypeBase.h:597
static Qualifiers removeCommonQualifiers(Qualifiers &L, Qualifiers &R)
Returns the common set of qualifiers while removing them from the given sets.
Definition TypeBase.h:384
bool hasOnlyConst() const
Definition TypeBase.h:458
@ OCL_Strong
Assigning into this object requires the old value to be released and the new value to be retained.
Definition TypeBase.h:361
@ OCL_ExplicitNone
This object can be modified without requiring retains or releases.
Definition TypeBase.h:354
@ OCL_None
There is no lifetime qualification on this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:350
@ OCL_Weak
Reading or writing from this object requires a barrier call.
Definition TypeBase.h:364
@ OCL_Autoreleasing
Assigning into this object requires a lifetime extension.
Definition TypeBase.h:367
void removeObjCLifetime()
Definition TypeBase.h:551
bool hasTargetSpecificAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:574
bool isStrictSupersetOf(Qualifiers Other) const
Determine whether this set of qualifiers is a strict superset of another set of qualifiers,...
Definition Type.cpp:57
bool hasNonFastQualifiers() const
Return true if the set contains any qualifiers which require an ExtQuals node to be allocated.
Definition TypeBase.h:638
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:804
bool operator!=(Qualifiers Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:768
bool hasConst() const
Definition TypeBase.h:457
bool hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() const
True if the lifetime is neither None or ExplicitNone.
Definition TypeBase.h:559
void addCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:502
bool hasCVRQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:487
void addConsistentQualifiers(Qualifiers qs)
Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set, given that they don't conflict.
Definition TypeBase.h:689
void removeFastQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:624
static bool isTargetAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LangAS A, LangAS B, const ASTContext &Ctx)
Definition Type.cpp:72
Qualifiers & operator+=(Qualifiers R)
Definition TypeBase.h:772
void removeFastQualifiers()
Definition TypeBase.h:628
bool hasQualifiers() const
Return true if the set contains any qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:646
void removeCVRQualifiers()
Definition TypeBase.h:499
Qualifiers withVolatile() const
Definition TypeBase.h:471
void addCVRUQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:506
Qualifiers & operator-=(Qualifiers R)
Definition TypeBase.h:784
bool compatiblyIncludes(Qualifiers other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set.
Definition TypeBase.h:727
bool hasUnaligned() const
Definition TypeBase.h:511
unsigned getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() const
Get the address space attribute value to be printed by diagnostics.
Definition TypeBase.h:578
bool hasAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:570
bool hasRestrict() const
Definition TypeBase.h:477
static bool isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LangAS A, LangAS B, const ASTContext &Ctx)
Returns true if address space A is equal to or a superset of B.
Definition TypeBase.h:708
void removeObjCGCAttr()
Definition TypeBase.h:523
void removeUnaligned()
Definition TypeBase.h:515
Qualifiers withoutAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:538
void removeRestrict()
Definition TypeBase.h:479
unsigned getFastQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:619
void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, bool appendSpaceIfNonEmpty=false) const
void removeAddressSpace()
Definition TypeBase.h:596
void addQualifiers(Qualifiers Q)
Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set.
Definition TypeBase.h:650
static Qualifiers fromCVRMask(unsigned CVR)
Definition TypeBase.h:435
void addUnaligned()
Definition TypeBase.h:516
void removePointerAuth()
Definition TypeBase.h:610
void setAddressSpace(LangAS space)
Definition TypeBase.h:591
unsigned getCVRUQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:489
bool isEmptyWhenPrinted(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const
bool hasVolatile() const
Definition TypeBase.h:467
PointerAuthQualifier getPointerAuth() const
Definition TypeBase.h:603
void setObjCGCAttr(GC type)
Definition TypeBase.h:520
Qualifiers withConst() const
Definition TypeBase.h:461
bool hasObjCGCAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:518
uint64_t getAsOpaqueValue() const
Definition TypeBase.h:455
void setCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:491
bool hasObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:544
ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:545
Qualifiers withoutObjCLifetime() const
Definition TypeBase.h:533
Qualifiers withoutObjCGCAttr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:528
static Qualifiers fromCVRUMask(unsigned CVRU)
Definition TypeBase.h:441
friend Qualifiers operator+(Qualifiers L, Qualifiers R)
Definition TypeBase.h:779
bool empty() const
Definition TypeBase.h:647
void setUnaligned(bool flag)
Definition TypeBase.h:512
void addFastQualifiers(unsigned mask)
Definition TypeBase.h:631
void removeVolatile()
Definition TypeBase.h:469
std::string getAsString() const
Qualifiers withRestrict() const
Definition TypeBase.h:481
void addPointerAuth(PointerAuthQualifier Q)
Definition TypeBase.h:611
void addObjCGCAttr(GC type)
Definition TypeBase.h:524
bool hasPointerAuth() const
Definition TypeBase.h:602
bool operator==(Qualifiers Other) const
Definition TypeBase.h:767
void removeQualifiers(Qualifiers Q)
Remove the qualifiers from the given set from this set.
Definition TypeBase.h:669
LangAS getAddressSpace() const
Definition TypeBase.h:571
bool hasOnlyVolatile() const
Definition TypeBase.h:468
void setPointerAuth(PointerAuthQualifier Q)
Definition TypeBase.h:606
Qualifiers()=default
bool compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(Qualifiers other) const
Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set of qualifiers from the narrow perspecti...
Definition TypeBase.h:750
Qualifiers getNonFastQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:639
static Qualifiers fromOpaqueValue(uint64_t opaque)
Definition TypeBase.h:448
bool hasStrongOrWeakObjCLifetime() const
True if the lifetime is either strong or weak.
Definition TypeBase.h:565
static std::string getAddrSpaceAsString(LangAS AS)
@ FastWidth
The width of the "fast" qualifier mask.
Definition TypeBase.h:376
@ MaxAddressSpace
The maximum supported address space number.
Definition TypeBase.h:373
@ FastMask
The fast qualifier mask.
Definition TypeBase.h:379
bool hasFastQualifiers() const
Definition TypeBase.h:618
bool hasOnlyRestrict() const
Definition TypeBase.h:478
bool isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(Qualifiers other, const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Returns true if the address space in these qualifiers is equal to or a superset of the address space ...
Definition TypeBase.h:719
void addObjCLifetime(ObjCLifetime type)
Definition TypeBase.h:552
void setObjCLifetime(ObjCLifetime type)
Definition TypeBase.h:548
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3643
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3641
Represents a struct/union/class.
Definition Decl.h:4309
Base for LValueReferenceType and RValueReferenceType.
Definition TypeBase.h:3571
bool isInnerRef() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3585
QualType getPointeeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3589
ReferenceType(TypeClass tc, QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef, bool SpelledAsLValue)
Definition TypeBase.h:3575
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3608
QualType getPointeeTypeAsWritten() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3587
bool isSpelledAsLValue() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3584
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3597
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Referencee, bool SpelledAsLValue)
Definition TypeBase.h:3601
Encodes a location in the source.
Stmt - This represents one statement.
Definition Stmt.h:85
The streaming interface shared between DiagnosticBuilder and PartialDiagnostic.
void AddTaggedVal(uint64_t V, DiagnosticsEngine::ArgumentKind Kind) const
Represents the declaration of a struct/union/class/enum.
Definition Decl.h:3714
Stores a list of template parameters for a TemplateDecl and its derived classes.
[BoundsSafety] Represents information of declarations referenced by the arguments of the counted_by a...
Definition TypeBase.h:3356
TypeCoupledDeclRefInfo(ValueDecl *D=nullptr, bool Deref=false)
D is to a declaration referenced by the argument of attribute.
Definition Type.cpp:3962
llvm::PointerIntPair< ValueDecl *, 1, unsigned > BaseTy
Definition TypeBase.h:3358
Base wrapper for a particular "section" of type source info.
Definition TypeLoc.h:59
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:6199
TypeOfKind getKind() const
Returns the kind of 'typeof' type this is.
Definition TypeBase.h:6189
TypeOfExprType(const ASTContext &Context, Expr *E, TypeOfKind Kind, QualType Can=QualType())
Definition Type.cpp:4086
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:6180
Expr * getUnderlyingExpr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6186
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:8259
QualType getType() const
Return the type wrapped by this type source info.
Definition TypeBase.h:8267
void overrideType(QualType T)
Override the type stored in this TypeSourceInfo. Use with caution!
Definition TypeBase.h:8273
TypeWithKeyword(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, TypeClass tc, QualType Canonical, TypeDependence Dependence)
Definition TypeBase.h:5953
FunctionTypeBitfields store various bits belonging to FunctionProtoType.
Definition TypeBase.h:1944
The base class of the type hierarchy.
Definition TypeBase.h:1833
bool isIncompleteOrObjectType() const
Return true if this is an incomplete or object type, in other words, not a function type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2485
bool isDecltypeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8746
bool isDependentSizedArrayType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8641
friend class ASTWriter
Definition TypeBase.h:2376
bool isFixedPointOrIntegerType() const
Return true if this is a fixed point or integer type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8942
bool isBlockPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8542
bool isVoidType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8878
TypedefBitfields TypedefBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2319
UsingBitfields UsingBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2321
bool hasPointeeToToCFIUncheckedCalleeFunctionType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8574
bool isBooleanType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:9008
bool isFunctionReferenceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8596
bool isSignableType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Definition TypeBase.h:8534
Type(const Type &)=delete
bool isObjCBuiltinType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8742
const TemplateSpecializationType * getAsNonAliasTemplateSpecializationType() const
Look through sugar for an instance of TemplateSpecializationType which is not a type alias,...
Definition Type.cpp:1921
bool isMFloat8Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8903
const Type * getPointeeOrArrayElementType() const
If this is a pointer type, return the pointee type.
Definition TypeBase.h:9058
bool isIncompleteArrayType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8629
bool isPlaceholderType() const
Test for a type which does not represent an actual type-system type but is instead used as a placehol...
Definition TypeBase.h:8854
bool isFloat16Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8887
ReferenceTypeBitfields ReferenceTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2325
bool isSignablePointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8538
ArrayTypeBitfields ArrayTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2314
const ArrayType * castAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const
A variant of castAs<> for array type which silently discards qualifiers from the outermost type.
Definition TypeBase.h:9177
Type(Type &&)=delete
bool isDependentAddressSpaceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8687
bool isUndeducedAutoType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8708
bool isRValueReferenceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8554
bool isFundamentalType() const
Tests whether the type is categorized as a fundamental type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8485
VectorTypeBitfields VectorTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2328
SubstPackTypeBitfields SubstPackTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2331
bool isConstantArrayType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8625
bool canDecayToPointerType() const
Determines whether this type can decay to a pointer type.
Definition TypeBase.h:9038
bool isArrayType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8621
bool isFunctionPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8589
bool isHLSLInlineSpirvType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8839
bool isConvertibleToFixedPointType() const
Return true if this can be converted to (or from) a fixed point type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8946
bool isArithmeticType() const
Definition Type.cpp:2337
bool isConstantMatrixType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8683
bool isHLSLBuiltinIntangibleType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8823
bool isPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8522
const TemplateSpecializationType * castAsNonAliasTemplateSpecializationType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:2947
bool isArrayParameterType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8637
TypeOfBitfields TypeOfBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2318
static constexpr int FunctionTypeNumParamsLimit
Definition TypeBase.h:1938
bool isIntegerType() const
isIntegerType() does not include complex integers (a GCC extension).
Definition TypeBase.h:8922
bool isObjCSelType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8736
const T * castAs() const
Member-template castAs<specific type>.
Definition TypeBase.h:9168
BuiltinTypeBitfields BuiltinTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2322
bool isSpecificPlaceholderType(unsigned K) const
Test for a specific placeholder type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8867
bool isReferenceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8546
bool isSignedFixedPointType() const
Return true if this is a fixed point type that is signed according to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
Definition TypeBase.h:8962
bool isObjectPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8558
bool isEnumeralType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8653
bool isVisibilityExplicit() const
Return true if the visibility was explicitly set is the code.
Definition TypeBase.h:3070
void addDependence(TypeDependence D)
Definition TypeBase.h:2372
ConstantArrayTypeBitfields ConstantArrayTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2315
Type(TypeClass tc, QualType canon, TypeDependence Dependence)
Definition TypeBase.h:2349
bool isScalarType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8980
bool isVariableArrayType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8633
bool isFloat128Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8907
bool isClkEventT() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8764
bool isSveVLSBuiltinType() const
Determines if this is a sizeless type supported by the 'arm_sve_vector_bits' type attribute,...
Definition Type.cpp:2608
CountAttributedTypeBitfields CountAttributedTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2334
bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8712
QualType getPointeeType() const
If this is a pointer, ObjC object pointer, or block pointer, this returns the respective pointee.
Definition Type.cpp:752
LinkageInfo getLinkageAndVisibility() const
Determine the linkage and visibility of this type.
Definition Type.cpp:5018
bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType() const
Determine whether this type is an integral or enumeration type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8996
bool isExtVectorType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8665
friend class ASTReader
Definition TypeBase.h:2375
bool isExtVectorBoolType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8669
Type & operator=(const Type &)=delete
bool isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8699
bool isImageType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8776
bool isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const
Test for a placeholder type other than Overload; see BuiltinType::isNonOverloadPlaceholderType.
Definition TypeBase.h:8872
bool isOCLIntelSubgroupAVCType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8797
AutoType * getContainedAutoType() const
Get the AutoType whose type will be deduced for a variable with an initializer of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2899
bool isPipeType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8783
bool isInstantiationDependentType() const
Determine whether this type is an instantiation-dependent type, meaning that the type involves a temp...
Definition TypeBase.h:2790
bool isMemberDataPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8614
bool isLValueReferenceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8550
bool isBitIntType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8787
bool isSpecificBuiltinType(unsigned K) const
Test for a particular builtin type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8847
bool isBuiltinType() const
Helper methods to distinguish type categories.
Definition TypeBase.h:8645
bool isOpenCLSpecificType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8812
bool isDependentType() const
Whether this type is a dependent type, meaning that its definition somehow depends on a template para...
Definition TypeBase.h:2782
bool isSignableIntegerType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const
Definition Type.cpp:5215
bool isFloat32Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8891
TypeBitfields TypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2313
bool isAnyComplexType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8657
bool isFixedPointType() const
Return true if this is a fixed point type according to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
Definition TypeBase.h:8934
bool isHalfType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8882
friend class TypePropertyCache
Definition TypeBase.h:2339
DeducedType * getContainedDeducedType() const
Get the DeducedType whose type will be deduced for a variable with an initializer of this type.
Definition Type.cpp:2056
bool isSaturatedFixedPointType() const
Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
Definition TypeBase.h:8950
bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const
Whether this type is or contains an unexpanded parameter pack, used to support C++0x variadic templat...
Definition TypeBase.h:2405
const BuiltinType * getAsPlaceholderType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8860
QualType getCanonicalTypeInternal() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3119
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:2347
bool isHLSLSpecificType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8830
bool isTemplateTypeParmType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8843
@ PtrdiffT
The "ptrdiff_t" type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2281
@ SizeT
The "size_t" type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2275
@ SignedSizeT
The signed integer type corresponding to "size_t".
Definition TypeBase.h:2278
bool isQueueT() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8768
PresefinedSugarTypeBitfields PredefinedSugarTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2335
bool isCompoundType() const
Tests whether the type is categorized as a compound type.
Definition TypeBase.h:8496
bool containsErrors() const
Whether this type is an error type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2776
const Type * getBaseElementTypeUnsafe() const
Get the base element type of this type, potentially discarding type qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:9051
bool isMemberPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8603
bool isAtomicType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8704
AttributedTypeBitfields AttributedTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2316
bool isFunctionProtoType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:2601
bool isIbm128Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8911
bool isOverloadableType() const
Determines whether this is a type for which one can define an overloaded operator.
Definition TypeBase.h:9021
bool isObjCIdType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8724
bool isMatrixType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8679
TagTypeBitfields TagTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2327
PackExpansionTypeBitfields PackExpansionTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2333
bool isVariablyModifiedType() const
Whether this type is a variably-modified type (C99 6.7.5).
Definition TypeBase.h:2800
bool isUnsaturatedFixedPointType() const
Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
Definition TypeBase.h:8958
UnresolvedUsingBitfields UnresolvedUsingBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2320
bool isObjCObjectType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8695
bool isFromAST() const
Whether this type comes from an AST file.
Definition TypeBase.h:2388
const ArrayType * getAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const
A variant of getAs<> for array types which silently discards qualifiers from the outermost type.
Definition TypeBase.h:9154
bool isUndeducedType() const
Determine whether this type is an undeduced type, meaning that it somehow involves a C++11 'auto' typ...
Definition TypeBase.h:9014
bool isObjectType() const
Determine whether this type is an object type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2510
bool isEventT() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8760
bool isDoubleType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8895
bool isPointerOrReferenceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8526
Type * this_()
Definition TypeBase.h:2366
KeywordWrapperBitfields KeywordWrapperBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2326
FunctionTypeBitfields FunctionTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2323
bool isBFloat16Type() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8899
void setDependence(TypeDependence D)
Definition TypeBase.h:2368
const T * getAsAdjusted() const
Member-template getAsAdjusted<specific type>.
Definition TypeBase.h:9118
bool isFunctionType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8518
bool isObjCObjectPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8691
SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBitfields SubstTemplateTypeParmTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2330
TypeDependence getDependence() const
Definition TypeBase.h:2771
Visibility getVisibility() const
Determine the visibility of this type.
Definition TypeBase.h:3065
bool isMemberFunctionPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8607
bool isUnsignedFixedPointType() const
Return true if this is a fixed point type that is unsigned according to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169.
Definition TypeBase.h:8976
bool isVectorType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8661
bool isObjCQualifiedClassType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8718
bool isObjCClassType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8730
bool isObjCInertUnsafeUnretainedType() const
Was this type written with the special inert-in-ARC __unsafe_unretained qualifier?
Definition TypeBase.h:2668
bool isRealFloatingType() const
Floating point categories.
Definition Type.cpp:2320
const T * getAsCanonical() const
If this type is canonically the specified type, return its canonical type cast to that specified type...
Definition TypeBase.h:2921
bool isHLSLAttributedResourceType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8835
ObjCObjectTypeBitfields ObjCObjectTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2324
TemplateTypeParmTypeBitfields TemplateTypeParmTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2329
@ STK_FloatingComplex
Definition TypeBase.h:2764
@ STK_ObjCObjectPointer
Definition TypeBase.h:2758
@ STK_IntegralComplex
Definition TypeBase.h:2763
@ STK_MemberPointer
Definition TypeBase.h:2759
bool isOCLExtOpaqueType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8805
const T * castAsCanonical() const
Return this type's canonical type cast to the specified type.
Definition TypeBase.h:2928
bool isAnyPointerType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8530
TypeClass getTypeClass() const
Definition TypeBase.h:2385
bool isCanonicalUnqualified() const
Determines if this type would be canonical if it had no further qualification.
Definition TypeBase.h:2411
bool isSubscriptableVectorType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8675
bool isSamplerT() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8756
const T * getAs() const
Member-template getAs<specific type>'.
Definition TypeBase.h:9101
const Type * getUnqualifiedDesugaredType() const
Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from the type, removing any typedefs,...
Definition Type.cpp:653
bool isNullPtrType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8915
bool isRecordType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8649
TemplateSpecializationTypeBitfields TemplateSpecializationTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2332
bool isTypedefNameType() const
Determines whether this type is written as a typedef-name.
Definition TypeBase.h:9029
static constexpr int FunctionTypeNumParamsWidth
Definition TypeBase.h:1937
@ NumTypeWithKeywordBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2059
bool isUnionType() const
Definition Type.cpp:718
bool isFunctionNoProtoType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:2600
bool isReserveIDT() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8772
bool hasObjCPointerRepresentation() const
Whether this type can represent an objective pointer type for the purpose of GC'ability.
Definition TypeBase.h:9047
bool hasPointerRepresentation() const
Whether this type is represented natively as a pointer.
Definition TypeBase.h:9042
AutoTypeBitfields AutoTypeBits
Definition TypeBase.h:2317
bool isCFIUncheckedCalleeFunctionType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8568
Type & operator=(Type &&)=delete
Base class for declarations which introduce a typedef-name.
Definition Decl.h:3559
TypedefNameDecl * getDecl() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6109
NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6104
QualType desugar() const
Definition Type.cpp:4041
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const TypedefNameDecl *Decl, QualType Underlying)
Definition TypeBase.h:6119
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:6079
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:6138
bool typeMatchesDecl() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6117
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:6133
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6111
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:6026
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6015
NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6006
UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl * getDecl() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6012
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D)
Definition TypeBase.h:6017
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:6030
Represents a dependent using declaration which was marked with typename.
Definition DeclCXX.h:4031
Represents a shadow declaration implicitly introduced into a scope by a (resolved) using-declaration ...
Definition DeclCXX.h:3393
UsingShadowDecl * getDecl() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6052
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6054
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:6067
NestedNameSpecifier getQualifier() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6048
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:6041
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, const UsingShadowDecl *D, QualType UnderlyingType)
Definition TypeBase.h:6057
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:6055
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:6070
Represent the declaration of a variable (in which case it is an lvalue) a function (in which case it ...
Definition Decl.h:711
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:3987
friend class StmtIteratorBase
Definition TypeBase.h:3976
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:3991
Expr * getSizeExpr() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3978
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:3965
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:3985
unsigned getNumElements() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4188
VectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType, VectorKind vecKind)
Definition Type.cpp:407
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:4197
bool isSugared() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4190
friend class ASTContext
Definition TypeBase.h:4175
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType, unsigned NumElements, TypeClass TypeClass, VectorKind VecKind)
Definition TypeBase.h:4202
VectorKind getVectorKind() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4193
QualType ElementType
The element type of the vector.
Definition TypeBase.h:4178
QualType desugar() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4191
QualType getElementType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:4187
static bool classof(const Type *T)
Definition TypeBase.h:4211
Code completion in a.
#define bool
Definition gpuintrin.h:32
Defines the Linkage enumeration and various utility functions.
mlir::Type getBaseType(mlir::Value varPtr)
@ AttributedType
The l-value was considered opaque, so the alignment was determined from a type, but that type was an ...
bool operator!=(const CommonEntityInfo &LHS, const CommonEntityInfo &RHS)
Definition Types.h:129
const internal::VariadicAllOfMatcher< Type > type
Matches Types in the clang AST.
const AstTypeMatcher< ArrayType > arrayType
const internal::VariadicAllOfMatcher< Decl > decl
Matches declarations.
uint32_t Literal
Literals are represented as positive integers.
Definition CNFFormula.h:35
std::variant< struct RequiresDecl, struct HeaderDecl, struct UmbrellaDirDecl, struct ModuleDecl, struct ExcludeDecl, struct ExportDecl, struct ExportAsDecl, struct ExternModuleDecl, struct UseDecl, struct LinkDecl, struct ConfigMacrosDecl, struct ConflictDecl > Decl
All declarations that can appear in a module declaration.
bool isLiteral(TokenKind K)
Return true if this is a "literal" kind, like a numeric constant, string, etc.
Definition TokenKinds.h:97
The JSON file list parser is used to communicate input to InstallAPI.
CanQual< Type > CanQualType
Represents a canonical, potentially-qualified type.
@ Overload
This is a legitimate overload: the existing declarations are functions or function templates with dif...
Definition Sema.h:812
bool isa(CodeGen::Address addr)
Definition Address.h:330
AutoTypeKeyword
Which keyword(s) were used to create an AutoType.
Definition TypeBase.h:1792
@ GNUAutoType
__auto_type (GNU extension)
Definition TypeBase.h:1800
@ DecltypeAuto
decltype(auto)
Definition TypeBase.h:1797
bool isTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS)
CanThrowResult
Possible results from evaluation of a noexcept expression.
FunctionType::ExtInfo getFunctionExtInfo(const Type &t)
Definition TypeBase.h:8420
bool isDynamicExceptionSpec(ExceptionSpecificationType ESpecType)
TypeDependenceScope::TypeDependence TypeDependence
void initialize(TemplateInstantiationCallbackPtrs &Callbacks, const Sema &TheSema)
@ Nullable
Values of this type can be null.
Definition Specifiers.h:352
RefQualifierKind
The kind of C++11 ref-qualifier associated with a function type.
Definition TypeBase.h:1780
@ RQ_None
No ref-qualifier was provided.
Definition TypeBase.h:1782
@ RQ_LValue
An lvalue ref-qualifier was provided (&).
Definition TypeBase.h:1785
@ RQ_RValue
An rvalue ref-qualifier was provided (&&).
Definition TypeBase.h:1788
@ TemplateName
The identifier is a template name. FIXME: Add an annotation for that.
Definition Parser.h:61
bool IsEnumDeclComplete(EnumDecl *ED)
Check if the given decl is complete.
Definition Decl.h:5330
ExprDependence computeDependence(FullExpr *E)
@ Vector
'vector' clause, allowed on 'loop', Combined, and 'routine' directives.
@ Self
'self' clause, allowed on Compute and Combined Constructs, plus 'update'.
TypeOfKind
The kind of 'typeof' expression we're after.
Definition TypeBase.h:918
bool operator==(const CallGraphNode::CallRecord &LHS, const CallGraphNode::CallRecord &RHS)
Definition CallGraph.h:204
nullptr
This class represents a compute construct, representing a 'Kind' of ‘parallel’, 'serial',...
TypeDependence toTypeDependence(ExprDependence D)
@ Dependent
Parse the block as a dependent block, which may be used in some template instantiations but not other...
Definition Parser.h:142
const StreamingDiagnostic & operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &DB, const ASTContext::SectionInfo &Section)
Insertion operator for diagnostics.
unsigned toTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS)
Linkage
Describes the different kinds of linkage (C++ [basic.link], C99 6.2.2) that an entity may have.
Definition Linkage.h:24
std::integral_constant< bool, std::is_same< T, ArrayType >::value|| std::is_base_of< ArrayType, T >::value > TypeIsArrayType
Definition TypeBase.h:9096
ObjCSubstitutionContext
The kind of type we are substituting Objective-C type arguments into.
Definition TypeBase.h:900
@ Superclass
The superclass of a type.
Definition TypeBase.h:914
@ Property
The type of a property.
Definition TypeBase.h:911
@ Parameter
The parameter type of a method or function.
Definition TypeBase.h:908
@ Result
The result type of a method or function.
Definition TypeBase.h:905
@ TypeAlignment
Definition TypeBase.h:76
@ TypeAlignmentInBits
Definition TypeBase.h:75
ArraySizeModifier
Capture whether this is a normal array (e.g.
Definition TypeBase.h:3717
ParameterABI
Kinds of parameter ABI.
Definition Specifiers.h:378
@ Ordinary
This parameter uses ordinary ABI rules for its type.
Definition Specifiers.h:380
const FunctionProtoType * T
bool isComputedNoexcept(ExceptionSpecificationType ESpecType)
@ Template
We are parsing a template declaration.
Definition Parser.h:81
bool isNoexceptExceptionSpec(ExceptionSpecificationType ESpecType)
TagTypeKind
The kind of a tag type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5888
constexpr unsigned PointerAuthKeyNone
bool IsEnumDeclScoped(EnumDecl *ED)
Check if the given decl is scoped.
Definition Decl.h:5340
@ Keyword
The name has been typo-corrected to a keyword.
Definition Sema.h:560
LangAS
Defines the address space values used by the address space qualifier of QualType.
void FixedPointValueToString(SmallVectorImpl< char > &Str, llvm::APSInt Val, unsigned Scale)
Definition Type.cpp:5464
bool operator!=(CanQual< T > x, CanQual< U > y)
PointerAuthenticationMode
Definition LangOptions.h:62
CallingConv
CallingConv - Specifies the calling convention that a function uses.
Definition Specifiers.h:278
@ AltiVecBool
is AltiVec 'vector bool ...'
Definition TypeBase.h:4143
@ SveFixedLengthData
is AArch64 SVE fixed-length data vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4152
@ AltiVecVector
is AltiVec vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4137
@ AltiVecPixel
is AltiVec 'vector Pixel'
Definition TypeBase.h:4140
@ Neon
is ARM Neon vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4146
@ Generic
not a target-specific vector type
Definition TypeBase.h:4134
@ RVVFixedLengthData
is RISC-V RVV fixed-length data vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4158
@ RVVFixedLengthMask
is RISC-V RVV fixed-length mask vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4161
@ NeonPoly
is ARM Neon polynomial vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4149
@ SveFixedLengthPredicate
is AArch64 SVE fixed-length predicate vector
Definition TypeBase.h:4155
U cast(CodeGen::Address addr)
Definition Address.h:327
@ None
The alignment was not explicit in code.
Definition ASTContext.h:146
ElaboratedTypeKeyword
The elaboration keyword that precedes a qualified type name or introduces an elaborated-type-specifie...
Definition TypeBase.h:5863
@ Interface
The "__interface" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5868
@ None
No keyword precedes the qualified type name.
Definition TypeBase.h:5884
@ Struct
The "struct" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5865
@ Class
The "class" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5874
@ Union
The "union" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5871
@ Enum
The "enum" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5877
@ Typename
The "typename" keyword precedes the qualified type name, e.g., typename T::type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5881
@ Other
Other implicit parameter.
Definition Decl.h:1745
ExceptionSpecificationType
The various types of exception specifications that exist in C++11.
@ EST_DependentNoexcept
noexcept(expression), value-dependent
@ EST_Uninstantiated
not instantiated yet
@ EST_Unparsed
not parsed yet
@ EST_NoThrow
Microsoft __declspec(nothrow) extension.
@ EST_None
no exception specification
@ EST_MSAny
Microsoft throw(...) extension.
@ EST_BasicNoexcept
noexcept
@ EST_NoexceptFalse
noexcept(expression), evals to 'false'
@ EST_Unevaluated
not evaluated yet, for special member function
@ EST_NoexceptTrue
noexcept(expression), evals to 'true'
@ EST_Dynamic
throw(T1, T2)
Visibility
Describes the different kinds of visibility that a declaration may have.
Definition Visibility.h:34
unsigned int uint32_t
Diagnostic wrappers for TextAPI types for error reporting.
Definition Dominators.h:30
__UINTPTR_TYPE__ uintptr_t
An unsigned integer type with the property that any valid pointer to void can be converted to this ty...
#define false
Definition stdbool.h:26
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition TypeBase.h:5959
const T * getType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5961
FunctionEffectWithCondition Rejected
Definition TypeBase.h:5230
FunctionEffectWithCondition Kept
Definition TypeBase.h:5229
A FunctionEffect plus a potential boolean expression determining whether the effect is declared (e....
Definition TypeBase.h:5001
FunctionEffectWithCondition(FunctionEffect E, const EffectConditionExpr &C)
Definition TypeBase.h:5005
Holds information about the various types of exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5321
FunctionDecl * SourceDecl
The function whose exception specification this is, for EST_Unevaluated and EST_Uninstantiated.
Definition TypeBase.h:5333
ExceptionSpecInfo(ExceptionSpecificationType EST)
Definition TypeBase.h:5341
FunctionDecl * SourceTemplate
The function template whose exception specification this is instantiated from, for EST_Uninstantiated...
Definition TypeBase.h:5337
ExceptionSpecificationType Type
The kind of exception specification this is.
Definition TypeBase.h:5323
ArrayRef< QualType > Exceptions
Explicitly-specified list of exception types.
Definition TypeBase.h:5326
Expr * NoexceptExpr
Noexcept expression, if this is a computed noexcept specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5329
Extra information about a function prototype.
Definition TypeBase.h:5349
FunctionTypeExtraAttributeInfo ExtraAttributeInfo
Definition TypeBase.h:5357
bool requiresFunctionProtoTypeArmAttributes() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5395
const ExtParameterInfo * ExtParameterInfos
Definition TypeBase.h:5354
bool requiresFunctionProtoTypeExtraAttributeInfo() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5399
ExtProtoInfo withCFIUncheckedCallee(bool CFIUncheckedCallee)
Definition TypeBase.h:5382
bool requiresFunctionProtoTypeExtraBitfields() const
Definition TypeBase.h:5388
void setArmSMEAttribute(AArch64SMETypeAttributes Kind, bool Enable=true)
Definition TypeBase.h:5403
ExtProtoInfo withExceptionSpec(const ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI)
Definition TypeBase.h:5376
A simple holder for a QualType representing a type in an exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:4695
unsigned AArch64SMEAttributes
Any AArch64 SME ACLE type attributes that need to be propagated on declarations and function pointers...
Definition TypeBase.h:4780
A holder for extra information from attributes which aren't part of an AttributedType.
Definition TypeBase.h:4724
StringRef CFISalt
A CFI "salt" that differentiates functions with the same prototype.
Definition TypeBase.h:4726
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition TypeBase.h:4730
unsigned NumExceptionType
The number of types in the exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:4704
Provides a few static helpers for converting and printing elaborated type keyword and tag type kind e...
Definition TypeBase.h:5907
static StringRef getTagTypeKindName(TagTypeKind Kind)
Definition TypeBase.h:5927
static StringRef getKeywordName(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword)
Definition Type.cpp:3310
static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeywordForTagTypeKind(TagTypeKind Tag)
Converts a TagTypeKind into an elaborated type keyword.
Definition Type.cpp:3259
static TagTypeKind getTagTypeKindForKeyword(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword)
Converts an elaborated type keyword into a TagTypeKind.
Definition Type.cpp:3276
static TagTypeKind getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec)
Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into a tag type kind.
Definition Type.cpp:3241
static bool KeywordIsTagTypeKind(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword)
Definition Type.cpp:3295
static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeywordForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec)
Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into an elaborated type keyword.
Definition Type.cpp:3222
Describes how types, statements, expressions, and declarations should be printed.
A std::pair-like structure for storing a qualified type split into its local qualifiers and its local...
Definition TypeBase.h:870
SplitQualType(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs)
Definition TypeBase.h:878
SplitQualType getSingleStepDesugaredType() const
Definition TypeBase.h:8278
friend bool operator==(SplitQualType a, SplitQualType b)
Definition TypeBase.h:887
const Type * Ty
The locally-unqualified type.
Definition TypeBase.h:872
friend bool operator!=(SplitQualType a, SplitQualType b)
Definition TypeBase.h:890
std::pair< const Type *, Qualifiers > asPair() const
Definition TypeBase.h:883
Qualifiers Quals
The local qualifiers.
Definition TypeBase.h:875
static inline ::clang::ExtQuals * getFromVoidPointer(void *P)
Definition TypeBase.h:105
static void * getAsVoidPointer(::clang::ExtQuals *P)
Definition TypeBase.h:103
static void * getAsVoidPointer(::clang::Type *P)
Definition TypeBase.h:92
static inline ::clang::Type * getFromVoidPointer(void *P)
Definition TypeBase.h:94
static void * getAsVoidPointer(clang::QualType P)
Definition TypeBase.h:1667
static clang::QualType getFromVoidPointer(void *P)
Definition TypeBase.h:1671
static SimpleType getSimplifiedValue(::clang::QualType Val)
Definition TypeBase.h:1659